US20020082199A1 - Insoluble insulin compositions - Google Patents

Insoluble insulin compositions Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20020082199A1
US20020082199A1 US10/010,038 US1003801A US2002082199A1 US 20020082199 A1 US20020082199 A1 US 20020082199A1 US 1003801 A US1003801 A US 1003801A US 2002082199 A1 US2002082199 A1 US 2002082199A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
acylated
insulin
human insulin
fatty acid
acid
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US10/010,038
Inventor
Mark Brader
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Individual
Original Assignee
Individual
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Individual filed Critical Individual
Priority to US10/010,038 priority Critical patent/US20020082199A1/en
Publication of US20020082199A1 publication Critical patent/US20020082199A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides
    • A61K38/16Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K38/17Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
    • A61K38/22Hormones
    • A61K38/28Insulins
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/08Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis
    • A61P3/10Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis for hyperglycaemia, e.g. antidiabetics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • A61P5/48Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the pancreatic hormones
    • A61P5/50Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the pancreatic hormones for increasing or potentiating the activity of insulin
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K14/00Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K14/435Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
    • C07K14/575Hormones
    • C07K14/62Insulins

Definitions

  • This invention is in the field of human medicine. More particularly, this invention is in the field of pharmaceutical treatment of the diseases of diabetes and hyperglycemia.
  • a rapid acting meal time insulin provided by bolus injections and a long-acting, so-called, basal insulin, administered by injection once or twice daily to control blood glucose levels between meals.
  • An ideal basal insulin will provide an extended and “flat” time action—that is, it will control blood glucose levels for at least 12 hours, and preferably for 24 hours or more, without significant risk of hypoglycemia.
  • an ideal basal insulin should be mixable with a soluble meal-time insulin, and should not cause irritation or reaction at the site of administration.
  • basal insulin preparations that are suspension formulations should be able to be readily, and uniformly resuspended by the patient prior to administration.
  • NPH insulin Neuronal Protamine Hagedorn
  • PZI protamine zinc insulin
  • UL ultralente
  • NPH insulin is the most widely-used insulin preparation, constituting from 50 to 70 percent of the insulin used worldwide. It is a suspension of a microcrystalline complex of insulin, zinc, protamine, and one or more phenolic preservatives.
  • NPH insulin preparations are commercially available incorporating human insulin, pork insulin, beef insulin, or mixtures thereof.
  • NPL NPH-like preparations of a monomeric insulin analog, LysB298, ProB29-human insulin analog, are known in the art [abbreviated herein as “NPL”: De Felippis, M. R., U.S. Pat. No. 5,461,031, issued Oct. 24, 1995; De Felippis, M. R., U.S. Pat. No. 5,650,486, issued Jul. 22, 1997; and De Felippis, M. R., U.S. Pat. No. 5,747,642, issued May 5, 1998].
  • NPH insulin microcrystals possess a distinctive rod-shaped morphology of typical dimensions about 5 microns long by 1 micron thick and 1 micron wide. The extended duration of action of NPH insulin microcrystals results from their slow absorption from the subcutaneous injection site.
  • NPH insulin preparations fails to provide the ideal “flat” pharmacokinetics necessary to maintain optimal fasting blood glucose for an extended period of time between meals. Consequently, treatment with NPH insulin can result in undesirably high levels of insulin in the blood, which may cause life-threatening hypoglycemia.
  • NPH insulin In addition to failing to provide an ideal flat pharmacokinetic profile, the duration of action of NPH insulin also is not ideal.
  • a major problem with NPH therapy is the “dawn phenomenon” which is hyperglycemia that results from the loss of effective glucose control overnight while the patient is sleeping.
  • Protamine zinc insulin has a composition similar to NPH, but contains higher levels of protamine and zinc than NPH. PZI preparations may be made as intermediate-acting amorphous precipitates or long-acting hacrystalline material. PZI, however, is not an ideal basal insulin pharmaceutical because it is not mixable with a soluble meal-time insulin, and the high zinc and protamine can cause irritation or reaction at the site of administration.
  • Human insulin ultralente is a microcrystalline preparation of insulin having higher levels of zinc than NPH, and not having either protamine or a phenolic preservative incorporated into the microcrystal. Human ultralente preparations provide moderate time action that is not suitably flat, and they do not form stable mixtures with insulin. Furthermore, they are difficult to resuspend.
  • the aforementioned fatty acid-acylated insulins are soluble at the usual therapeutic concentrations of insulin.
  • the time action of these preparations may not be sufficiently long enough, or flat enough, to provide ideal, basal control, and they are less potent than insulin, thereby requiring administration of greater amounts of the drug agent [Radziuk, J., et al., Diabetoloia 41:116-120, 489-490 (1998)].
  • Whittingham, J. L., et al. [ Biochemistry 36:2826-2831 (1997)] crystallized B29-N ⁇ -tetradecanoyl-des(B30)-human insulin analog as a hexamer complex with zinc and phenol for the purpose of structural studies by X-ray crystallography. The hexamer was found to be in the R6 conformation, and to have certain properties different from hexamers of human insulin. Whittingham, et al. do not disclose any pharmaceutical or pharmacological properties of the crystal that was formed, nor do they suggest that such a crystal would have any advantageous properties for treating diabetes or hyperglycemia. It is not possible to predict from Whittingham, et al. whether protamine-containing crystals of the NPH type could be formed with derivatized insulins and insulin analogs, or what the pharmacokinetice or pharmacodynamic response of such crystals would be.
  • the present invention provides insoluble compositions comprising a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of insulin derivatives, insulin analog derivatives, and proinsulin derivatives, wherein the derivatives are less soluble than the underivatized insulin, insulin analog, or proinsulin.
  • the insoluble compositions also are comprised of a complexing compound, a hexamer-stabilizing compound, and a divalent metal cation. These insoluble compositions are useful for treating diabetes and hyperglycemia, and provide the advantages of having flatter and longer time action than NPE insulin. Furthermore, they are mixable in a formulation with soluble protein and with soluble derivatized protein.
  • the insoluble compositions of the present invention are in the form of amorphous precipitates, and also more preferably, in the form of microcrystals.
  • the present invention provides microcrystalline forms of fatty acid-acylated proteins that are useful for treating diabetes and hyperglycemia.
  • These microcrystals comprise a fatty acid-acylated protein selected from the group consisting of fatty acid-acylated insulin, fatty acid-acylated insulin analog, and fatty acid-acylated proinsulin, protamine, a phenolic preservative, and zinc.
  • Such microcrystals will provide both flatter and longer time action than NPH insulin, and are mixable with soluble proteins and soluble derivatized proteins.
  • the invention provides aqueous suspension formulations comprising the insoluble composition and an aqueous solvent.
  • Such suspension formulations may contain, optionally, a soluble protein, such as human insulin, or a soluble analog of human insulin, such as a monomeric insulin analog, that control blood glucose immediately following a meal.
  • the microcrystalline formulations of fatty acid-acylated insulins have superior pharmacodynamics compared with human insulin NPH.
  • the present invention is distinct from previous fatty acid-acylated insulin technology in that the extension of time action of the present invention does not rely necessarily on albumin-binding, though albumin binding may further protract the time action of certain of the compositions of the present invention.
  • the invention also pertains to a process for preparing the insoluble compositions, and a method of treating diabetes or hyperglycemia comprising administering a formulation containing an insoluble composition to a patient in need thereof in a quantity sufficient to regulate blood glucose levels in the patient.
  • amorphous precipitates comprising, in their broadest aspect, a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of derivatized insulin, derivatized insulin analog, and derivatized proinsulin, protamine, a phenolic preservative, and zinc, wherein the derivatized protein is less soluble than the underivatized protein.
  • insoluble composition refers to matter in either a microcrystalline state or in an amorphous precipitate state.
  • the presence of microcrystals or amorphous precipitate can be ascertained by visual and microscopic examination. Solubility depends on solvent, and a particular composition may be insoluble in one solvent, but soluble in another.
  • microcrystal means a solid that is comprised primarily of matter in a crystalline state, wherein the individual crystals are predominantly of a single crystallographic composition and are of a microscopic size, typically of longest dimension within the range 1 micron to 100 microns.
  • microcrystalline refers to the state of being a microcrystal.
  • amorphous precipitate refers to Winsoluble material that is not crystalline in form. The person of ordinary skill can distinguish crystals from amorphous precipitate.
  • the amorphous precipitates of the present invention have advantageous pharmacological properties in their own right, and also are intermediates in the formation of the microcrystals of the present invention.
  • derivatized protein refers to a protein selected from the group consisting of derivatized insulin, derivatized insulin analogs, and derivatized proinsulin that is derivatized by a functional group such that the derivatized protein is less soluble in an aqueous solvent than is the un-derivatized protein.
  • derivatized proteins are known in the art, and the determination of solubility of proteins and derivatized proteins is well-known to the skilled person.
  • Examples of derivatized insulin and insulin analogs include benzoyl, p-tolyl-sulfonamide carbonyl, and indolyl derivatives of insulin and insulin analogs [Havelund, S., et al., WO95/07931, published Mar. 23, 1995]; alkyloxycarbonyl derivatives of insulin [Geiger, R., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 3,684,791, issued Aug. 15, 1972; Brandenberg, D., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 3,907,763, issued Sep. 23, 1975]; aryloxycarbonyl derivatives of insulin [Brandenberg, D., et al., U.S. Pat. No.
  • acylated protein refers to a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of insulin, insulin analogs, and proinsulin that is acylated with an organic acid moiety that is bonded to the protein through an amide bond formed between the acid group of an organic acid compound and an amino group of the protein.
  • the amino group may be the ⁇ -amino group of an N-terminal amino acid of the protein, or may be the ⁇ -amino group of a Lys residue of the protein.
  • An acylated protein may be acylated at one or more of the three amino groups that are present in insulin and in most insulin analogs.
  • Mono-acylated proteins are acylated at a single amino group.
  • Di-acylated proteins are acylated at two amino groups. Tri-acylated proteins are acylated at three amino groups.
  • the organic acid compound may be, for example, a fatty acid, an aromatic acid, or any other organic compound having a carboxylic acid group that will form an amide bond with an amino group of a protein, and that will cause the aqueous solubility of the derivatized protein to be lower than the solubility of the un-derivatized protein.
  • fatty acid-acylated protein refers to a an acylated protein selected from the group consisting of insulin, insulin analogs, and proinsulins that is acylated with a fatty acid that is bonded to the protein through an amide bond formed between the acid group of the fatty acid and an amino group of the protein.
  • the amino group may be the ⁇ -amino group of an N-terminal amino acid of the protein, or may be the ⁇ -amino group of a Lys residue of the protein.
  • a fatty acid-acylated protein may be acylated at one or more of the three amino groups that are present in insulin and in most insulin analogs.
  • Mono-acylated proteins are acylated at a single amino group.
  • Di-acylated proteins are acylated at two amino groups. Tri-acylated proteins are acylated at three amino groups.
  • Fatty acid-acylated insulin is disclosed in a Japanese patent application 1-254, 699. See also, Hashimoto, M., et al., Pharmaceutical Research, 6:171-176 (1989), and Lindsay, D. G., et al., Biochemical J. 121:737-745 (1971). Further disclosure of fatty acid-acylated insulins and fatty acylated insulin analogs, and of methods for their synthesis, is found in Baker, J. C., et al, U.S. Ser. No. 08/342,931, filed Nov. 17, 1994 and issued as U.S. Pat. No.
  • fatty acid-acylated protein includes pharmaceutically acceptable salts and complexes of fatty acid-acylated proteins.
  • fatty acid-acylated protein also includes preparations of acylated proteins wherein the population of acylated protein molecules is homogeneous with respect to the site or sites of acylation.
  • N ⁇ -mono-acylated protein, B1-N ⁇ -mono-acylated protein, A1-N ⁇ -mono-acylated protein, A1, B1-N ⁇ -di-acylated protein, N ⁇ , A1-N ⁇ , di-acylated protein, N ⁇ , B1-N ⁇ , di-acylated protein, and N ⁇ , A1, B1-N ⁇ , tri-acylated protein are all encompassed within the term “fatty acid-acylated proteins” for the purpose of the present invention.
  • the term also refers to preparations wherein the population of acylated protein molecules has heterogeneous acylation.
  • fatty acid-acylated protein includes mixtures of mono-acylated and di-acylated proteins, mixtures of mono-acylated and tri-acylated proteins, mixtures of di-acylated and tri-acylated proteins, and mixtures of mono-acylated, di-acylated, and tri-acylated proteins.
  • insulins refers to human insulin, whose amino acid sequence and special structure are well-known. Human insulin is comprised of a twenty-one amino acid A-chain and a thirty-amino acid B-chain which are cross-linked by disulfide bonds. A properly cross-linked insulin contains three disulfide bridges: one between position 7 of the A-chain and position 7 of the B-chain, a second between position 20 of the A-chain and position 19 of the B-chain, and a third between positions 6 and 11 of the A-chain.
  • insulin analog means proteins that have an A-chain and a B-chain that have substantially the same amino acid sequences as the A-chain and B-chain of human insulin, respectively, but differ from the A-chain and B-chain of human insulin by having one or more amino acid deletions, one or more amino acid replacements, and/or one or more amino acid additions that do not destroy the insulin activity of the insulin analog.
  • Animal insulins are insulin analogs. Four such animal insulins are rabbit, pork, beef, and sheep insulin. The amino acid substitutions that distinguish these animal insulins from human insulin are presented below for the reader's convenience. Amino Acid Position A8 A9 A10 B30 human insulin Thr Ser Ile Thr rabbit insulin Thr Ser Ile Ser pork insulin Thr Ser Ile Ala beef insulin Ala Ser Val Ala sheep insulin Ala Gly Val Ala
  • Monomeric insulin analog is well-known in the art.
  • Monomeric insulin analogs are structurally very similar to human insulin, and have activity similar or equal to human insulin, but have one or more amino acid deletions, replacements or additions that tend to disrupt the contacts involved in dimerization and hexamerization which results in their greater tendency to dissociate to less aggregated states.
  • Monomeric insulin analogs are rapid-acting analogs of human insulin, and are disclosed, for example, in Chance, R. E., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,646, May 7, 1996; Brems, D. N., et al. Protein Engineering 5:527-533 (1992); Brange, J. J.
  • An example of monomeric insulin analogs is described as human insulin wherein Pro at position B28 is substituted with Asp, Lys, Leu, Val, or Ala, and wherein Lys at position B29 is Lys or is substituted with Pro, and also, AlaB26-human insulin, des(B28-B30)-human insulin, and des(B27)-human insulin.
  • the monomeric insulin analogs employed as derivatives in the present crystals, or employed un-derivatized in the solution phase of suspension formulations, are properly cross-linked at the same positions as is human insulin.
  • insulin analogs for use in the present invention are those wherein the isoelectric point of the insulin analog is between about 7.0 and about 8.0. These analogs are referred to as “pI-shifted insulin analogs.” Examples of such insulin analogs include ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, ArgA0, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, and ArgA0, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin.
  • Another group of insulin analogs consists of insulin analogs that have one or more amino acid deletions that do not significantly disrupt the activity of the molecule.
  • This group of insulin analogs is designated herein as “deletion analogs.”
  • insulin analogs with deletion of one or more amino acids at positions B1-B3 are active.
  • insulin analogs with deletion of one or more amino acids at positions B28-B30 are active.
  • Examples of “deletion analogs” include des(B30)-human insulin, desPhe(B1)-human insulin, des(B27)-human insulin, des(B28-B30)-human insulin, and des(B1-B3)-human insulin.
  • the deletion analogs employed as derivatives in the present crystals, or employed un-derivatized in the solution phase of suspension formulations are properly cross-linked at the same positions as is human insulin.
  • an insulin analog may have replacements of one or more of its amidated amino acids with other amino acids for the sake of chemical stability.
  • Asn and Gln may be replaced with Gly, Ser, Thr, Asp or Glu.
  • AsnAl8, AsnA21, or AsnB3, or any combination of those residues may be replaced by Gly, Asp, or Glu, for example.
  • GlnA15 or GlnB4, or both, may be replaced by either Asp or Glu.
  • Preferred replacements are Asp at B21, and Asp at B3.
  • proinsulin means a single-chain peptide molecule that is a precursor of insulin.
  • Proinsulin may be converted to insulin or to an insulin analog by chemical or, preferably, enzyme-catalyzed reactions.
  • proinsulin proper disulfide bonds are formed as described herein.
  • Proinsulin comprises insulin or an insulin analog and a connecting bond or a connecting peptide.
  • a connecting peptide has between 1 and about 35 amino acids.
  • the connecting bond or connecting peptide connects to a terminal amino acid of the A-chain and to a terminal amino acid of the B-chain by an ⁇ -amide bond or by two ⁇ -amide bonds, respectively.
  • none of the amino acids in the connecting peptide is cysteine.
  • the C-terminal amino acid of the connecting peptide is Lys or Arg.
  • Proinsulin may have the formula X—B—C—A—Y or may have the formula X—A—C—B—Y, wherein X is hydrogen or is a peptide of from 1 to about 100 amino acids that has either Lys or Arg at its C-terminal amino acid, Y is hydroxy, or is a peptide of from 1 to about 100 amino acids that has either Lys or Arg at its N-terminal amino acid, A is the A-chain of insulin or the A-chain of an insulin analog, C is a peptide of from 1 to about 35 amino acids, none of which is cysteine, wherein the C-terminal amino acid is Lys or Arg, and B is the B-chain of insulin or the B-chain of an insulin analog.
  • a “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” means a salt formed between any one or more of the charged groups in a protein and any one or more pharmaceutically acceptable, non-toxic cations or anions
  • organic and inorganic salts include, for example, those prepared from acids such as hydrochloric, sulfuric, sulfonic, tartaric, fumaric, hydrobromic, glycolic, citric, maleic, phosphoric, succinic, acetic, nitric, benzoic, ascorbic, p-toluenesulfonic, benzenesulfonic, naphthalenesulfonic, propionic, carbonic, and the like, or for example, ammonium, sodium, potassium, calcium, or magnesium.
  • acylate means to form the amide bond between a fatty acid and an amino group of a protein.
  • a protein is “acylated” when one or more of its amino groups is combined in an amide bond with the acid group of a fatty acid.
  • fatty acid means a saturated or unsaturated, straight chain or branched chain fatty acid, having from one to eighteen carbon atoms.
  • C1 to C18 fatty acid refers to a saturated, straight chain or branched chain fatty acid having from one to eighteen carbon atoms.
  • the term “divalent metal cation” refers to the ion or ions that participate to form a complex with a multiplicity of protein molecules.
  • the transition metals, the alkaline metals, and the alkaline earth metals are examples of metals that are known to form complexes with insulin.
  • the transitional metals are preferred.
  • Zinc is particularly preferred.
  • Other transition metals that may be pharmaceutically acceptable for complexing with insulin proteins include copper, cobalt, and iron.
  • complex has two meanings in the present invention.
  • the term refers to a complex formed between one or more atoms in the proteins that form the complex and one or more divalent metal cations.
  • the atoms in the proteins serve as electron-donating ligands.
  • the proteins typically form a hexamer complex with divalent transition metal cations.
  • the second meaning of “complex” in the present invention is the association between the complexing compound and hexamers.
  • the “complexing compound” is an organic molecule that typically has a multiplicity of positive charges that binds to, or complexes with hexamers in the insoluble composition, thereby stabilizing them against dissolution.
  • complexing compounds suitable in the present invention include protamine, surfen, various globin proteins [Brange, J. , Galenics of Insulin, Springer-Verlag, Berlin Heidelberg (1987)], and various polycationic polymer compounds known to complex with insulin.
  • protamine refers to a mixture of strongly basic proteins obtained from fish sperm. The average molecular weight of the proteins in protamine is about 4,200 [Hoffmann, J. A., et al., Protein Expression and Purification, 1:127-133 (1990)]. “Protamine” can refer to a relatively salt-free preparation of the proteins, often called “protamine base.” Protamine also refers to preparations comprised of salts of the proteins. Commercial preparations vary widely in their salt content.
  • Protamines are well-known to those skilled in the insulin art and are currently incorporated into NPH insulin products. A pure fraction of protamine is operable in the present invention, as well as mixtures of proteins. Commercial preparations of protamine, however, are typically not homogeneous with respect to the proteins present. These are nevertheless operative in the present invention.
  • Protamine comprised of protamine base is operative in the present invention, as are protamine preparations comprised of salts of protamine, and those that are mixtures of protamine base and protamine salts.
  • Protamine sulfate is a frequently used protamine salt.
  • suspension refers to a mixture of a liquid phase and a solid phase that consists of insoluble or sparingly soluble particles that are larger than colloidal size. Mixtures of NPH microcrystals and an aqueous solvent form suspensions. Mixtures of amorphous precipitate and an aqueous solvent also forms a suspension.
  • the term “suspension formulation” means a pharmaceutical composition wherein an active agent is present in a solid phase, for example, a microcrystalline solid, an amorphous precipitate, or both, which is finely dispersed in an aqueous solvent.
  • the finely dispersed solid is such that it may be suspended in a fairly uniform manner throughout the aqueous solvent by the action of gently agitating the mixture, thus providing a reasonably uniform suspension from which a dosage volume may be extracted.
  • Examples of commercially available insulin suspension formulations include, for example, NPH, PZI, and ultralente.
  • a small proportion of the solid matter in a microcrystalline suspension formulation may be amorphous.
  • the proportion of amorphous material is less than 10%, and most preferably, less than 1% of the solid matter in a microcrystalline suspension.
  • a small proportion of the solid matter in an amorphous precipitate suspension may be microcrystalline.
  • NPH insulin refers to the “Neutral Protamine Hagedorn” preparation of insulin. The meaning of such a term, and the methods for preparing such a preparation of insulin will be familiar to the person of ordinary skill in the insulin formulation art.
  • aqueous solvent refers to a liquid solvent that contains water.
  • An aqueous solvent system may be comprised solely of water, may be comprised of water plus one or more miscible solvents, and may contain solutes.
  • miscible solvents are the short-chain organic alcohols, such as, methanol, ethanol, propanol, short-chain ketones, such as acetone, and polyalcohols, such as glycerol.
  • An “isotonicity agent” is a compound that is physiologically tolerated and imparts a suitable tonicity to a formulation to prevent the net flow of water across cell membranes that are in contact with an administered formulation.
  • Glycerol which is also known as glycerin, is commonly used as an isotonicity agent.
  • Other isotonicity agents include salts, e.g., sodium chloride, and monosaccharides, e.g., dextrose and lactose.
  • the insoluble compositions of the present invention contain a hexamer-stabilizing compound.
  • hexamer-stabilizing compound refers to a non-proteinaceous, small molecular weight compound that stabilizes the derivatized protein in a hexameric aggregation state. Phenolic compounds, particularly phenolic preservatives, are the best known stabilizing compounds for insulin and insulin derivatives. Such a hexamer-stabilizing compound stabilizes the insulin hexamer by binding to it through specific inter-molecular contacts.
  • hexamer-stabilizing agents include: various phenolic compounds, phenolic preservatives, resorcinol, 4′-hydroxyacetanilide (tylenol), 4-hydroxybenzamide, and 2,7-dihydroxynaphthalene.
  • Multi-use formulations of the insoluble compositions of the present invention will contain a preservative, in addition to a hexamer-stabilizing compound.
  • the preservative used in formulations of the present invention may be a phenolic preservative.
  • preservative refers to a compound added to a pharmaceutical formulation to act as an anti-microbial agent.
  • a parenteral formulation must meet guidelines for preservative effectiveness to be a commercially viable multi-use product.
  • preservatives known in the art as being effective and acceptable in parenteral formulations are benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium, chlorohexidine, phenol, m-cresol, benzyl alcohol, methylparaben, chlorobutanole o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, phenylmercuric nitrate, thimerosal, benzoic acid, and various mixtures thereof. See, e.g., Wallophusser, K.-H., Develop. Biol. Standard, 24:9-28 (1974) (S. Krager, Basel).
  • phenolic preservative includes the compounds phenol, m-cresol, o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, methylparaben, and mixtures thereof. Certain phenolic preservatives, such as phenol and m-cresol, are known to bind to insulin-like molecules and thereby to induce conformational changes that increase either physical or chemical stability, or both [Birnbaum, D. T., et al., Pharmaceutical. Res. 14:25-36 (1997); Rahuel-Clermont, S., et al., Biochemistry 36:5837-5845 (1997)].
  • buffer or “pharmaceutically acceptable buffer” refers to a compound that is known to be safe for use in insulin formulations and that has the effect of controlling the pH of the formulation at the pH desired for the formulation.
  • the pH of the formulations of the present invention is from about 6.0 to about 8.0.
  • the formulations of the present invention have a pH between about 6.8 and about 7.8.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable buffers for controlling pH at a moderately acidic pH to a moderately basic pH include such compounds as phosphate, acetate, citrate, arginine, TRIS, and histidine.
  • TRIS amino-2-hydroxymethyl-1,3,-propanediol, and to any pharmacologically acceptable salt thereof.
  • TRIS is also known in the art as trimethylol aminomethane, tromethamine, and tris(hydroxymethyl)aminomethane.
  • Other buffers that are pharmaceutically acceptable, and that are suitable for controlling pH at the desired level are known to the chemist of ordinary skill.
  • administer means to introduce a formulation of the present invention into the body of a patient in need thereof to treat a disease or condition.
  • treating refers to the management and care of a patient having diabetes or hyperglycemia, or other condition for which insulin administration is indicated for the purpose of combating or alleviating symptoms and complications of those conditions. Treating includes administering a formulation of present invention to prevent the onset of the symptoms or complications, alleviating the symptoms or complications, or eliminating the disease, condition, or disorder.
  • the present invention provides insoluble compositions that have properties similar to NPH insulin in certain respects, and superior to NPH insulin in other respects. They are similar to NPH insulin in respect to their physical properties.
  • a light microscope equipped with an oil immersion objective and a crossed polarizer was utilized to examine microcrystals comprised of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin, zinc, protamine, and phenol, prepared according to the method of Preparation 18. Examination at 1000 ⁇ magnification showed that the B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals were single and rod-like like, exhibiting a uniform crystal morphology.
  • the sizes of these microcrystals fell generally within the range of approximately 2 microns long to 8 microns long. A direct comparison using this microscope showed that the morphology of these microcrystals appeared to be similar to that of commercially manufactured pork NPH microcrystals, which has elsewhere been described as rod-like. The size range of these B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals was also similar to that of commercially manufactured NPH microcrystals, which generally have an average length of about 5 microns. The commercial manufacturing specification for the mean length of NPH microcrystals is from 1 micron to 40 microns.
  • microcrystals of the present invention are, however, unexpectedly and unpredictably different from NPH insulin crystals in their dissolution properties, and in their time action.
  • the microcrystals of the present invention dissolve much more slowly under conditions that simulate physiologic conditions than do NPH insulin crystals, and provide a longer and flatter profile of blood glucose control than does NPH insulin. This was demonstrated by the following experiments.
  • the dissolution rate of crystals of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin prepared in accordance with the present invention was found to be markedly longer than that of a commercially manufactured NPH-pork insulin. This was most unexpected in view of the data above.
  • the dissolution rate of the NPH-pork insulin was measured by placing 5 microliters of U100 NPH-pork insulin into 3 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium or magnesium) in a 1 cm path length square quartz cuvette at a temperature of 22° C. This solution was stirred at a constant rate using a magnetic cuvette stirrer.
  • Subcutaneous interstitial fluid contains 0.3 mM human serum albumin. Therefore, another experiment was designed to compare the dissolution rates of approximately equal quantities of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals and pork NPH microcrystals in Dulbeccols phosphate buffered saline containing 0.3 mM human serum albumin.
  • This experiment was performed by placing 25 microliters of NPH pork insulin (approximately 3.5 mg insulin/mL) into 2 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium and magnesium) containing 0.3 mM human serum albumin. The resulting suspension was swirled gently by hand whereupon the microcrystals were observed to be dissolved after about 3 to 5 minutes.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals were observed by placing 50 microliters of a B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin microcrystalline formulation (approximately 1.8 mg/mL), prepared essentially as described in Preparation 18 herein, into 2 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium and magnesium) containing 0.3 mM human serum albumin. The resulting suspension was swirled gently by hand for about 3 to 5 minutes whereupon minimal dissolution of the suspended microcrystals was observed to have taken place. Continued gentle stirring of this solution using a magnetic stirrer resulted in complete dissolution of the suspended B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals after about 2 hours.
  • the insoluble compositions of the present invention may be crystals with rod-like morphology or with an irregular morphology, or they may be amorphous precipitates.
  • Preferred insoluble compositions are comprised of acylated insulin or acylated insulin analog, zinc ions, which are present at about 0.3 to about 0.7 mole per mole of derivatized protein, a phenolic preservative selected from the group consisting of phenol, m-cresol, o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, methylparaben, and mixtures thereof and is present in sufficient proportions with respect to the derivatized protein to facilitate formation of the R6 hexamer conformation, and protamine, which is present at about 0.15 to about 0.7 mole per mole of derivatized protein.
  • the preferred derivatized proteins are acylated proteins, and the preferred acylated proteins for the microcrystals and formulations of the present invention are fatty acid-acylated insulin, and fatty acid-acylated insulin analogs.
  • Fatty acid-acylated human insulin is highly preferred.
  • Fatty acid-acylated insulin analogs are equally highly preferred.
  • a preferred group of insulin analogs for preparing acylated insulin analogs used to form the microcrystals of the present invention consists of insulin analogs wherein the amino acid residue at position B28 is Asp, Lys, Leu, Val, or Ala, the amino acid residue at position B29 is Lys or Pro, the amino acid residue at position B10 is His or Asp, the amino acid residue at position B3 is Phe, Asp or deleted alone or in combination with a deletion of the residue at position B2, the amino acid residue at position B30 is Thr, Ala, Ser, or deleted, and the amino acid residue at position B9 is Ser or Asp; provided that either position B28 or B29 is Lys.
  • Another preferred group of insulin analogs for use in the present invention consists of those wherein the isoelectric point of the insulin analog is between about 7.0 and about 8.0. These analogs are referred to as “pI-shifted insulin analogs.” Examples of pI-shifted insulin analogs include, for example, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, ArgA0, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, and ArgA0, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin.
  • Another preferred group of insulin analogs consists of LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (B28 is Lys; B29 is Pro); AspB28-human insulin (B28 is Asp), AspB1-human insulin, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, ArgA0-human insulin, AspB1, GluB13-human insulin, AlaB26-human insulin, GlyA21-human insulin, des(ThrB30)-human insulin, and GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin.
  • Especially preferred insulin analogs include LysB28, ProB29-human insulin, des(ThrB30)-human insulin, AspB28-human insulin, and AlaB26-human insulin.
  • Another especially preferred insulin analog is GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin [Dörschug, M., U.S. Pat. No. 5,656,722, Aug. 12, 1997].
  • the most preferred insulin analog is LysB28, ProB29-human insulin.
  • acylating moieties consists of fatty acids that are straight chain and saturated. This group consists of methanoic acid (C1), ethanoic acid (C2), propanoic acid (C3), n-butanoic acid (C4), n-pentanoic acid (C5), n-hexanoic acid (C6), n-heptanoic acid (C7), n-octanoic acid (C 8 ), n-nonanoic acid (C9), n-decanoic acid (C10), n-undecanoic acid (C11), n-dodecanoic acid (C12), n-tridecanoic acid (C13), n-tetradecanoic acid (C14), n-pentadecanoic acid (CIS), n-hexadecanoic acid (C16), n-heptadecanoic acid (C17), and n-o
  • Adjectival forms are formyl (C1), acetyl (C2), propionyl (C3), butyryl (C4), pentanoyl (C5), hexanoyl (C6), heptanoyl (C7), octanoyl (C8), nonanoyl (C9), decanoyl (C10), undecanoyl (C11), dodecanoyl (C12), tridecanoyl (C13), tetradecanoyl (C14) or myristoyl, pentadecanoyl (C15), hexadecanoyl (C16) or palmitic, heptadecanoyl (C17), and octadecanoyl (C18).
  • a preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having an even number of carbon atoms—that is, C2, C4, C6, C8, C10, C12, C14, C16, and C18 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having an odd number of carbon atoms—that is, C1, C3, C5, C7, C9, C11, C13, C15, and C17 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than 5 carbon atoms—that is, C6, C7, C8, C9, C10, C11, C12, C13, C14, C15, C16, C17, and C18 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having less than 9 carbon atoms—that is, C1, C2, C3, C4, C5, C6, C7, and C18 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having between 6 and B carbon atoms—that is, C6, C7, and C8, saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than between 4 and 6 carbon atoms—that is, C4, C5, and C6, saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than between 2 and 4 carbon atoms—that is, C2, C3, and C4, saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having less than 6 carbon atoms—that is, C1, C2, C3, C4, and C5 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having less than 4 carbon atoms—that is, C1, C2, and C3 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than 9 carbon atoms—that is, C10, C11, C12, C13, C14, C15, C16, C17, and C18 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having an even number of carbon atoms and more than 9 carbon atom—that is, C10, C12, C14, C16, and C18 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having 12, 14, or 16 carbon atoms, that is, C12, C14, and C16 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having 14 or 16 carbon atoms, that is, C14 and C16 saturated fatty acids. Fatty acids with 14 carbons are particularly preferred. Fatty acids with 16 carbons are also particularly preferred.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of saturated fatty acids having between 4 and 10 carbon atoms, that is C4, C5, C6, C7, C8, C9, and C10 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of saturated fatty acids having an even number of carbon atoms between 4 and 10 carbon atoms, that is C4, C6, C8, and C10 saturated fatty acids.
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having between 6, 8, or 10 carbon atoms. Fatty acids with 6 carbons are particularly preferred. Fatty acids with a carbons are also particularly preferred. Fatty acids with 10 carbons are particularly preferred.
  • a preferred group of acylating moieties consists of saturated fatty acids that are branched.
  • a branched fatty acid has at least two branches.
  • the length of a ubranchu of a branched fatty acid may be described by the number of carbon atoms in the branch, beginning with the acid carbon.
  • the branched fatty acid 3-ethyl-5-methylhexanoic acid has three branches that are five, six, and six carbons in length.
  • the “longest” branch is six carbons.
  • 2,3,4,5-tetraethyloctanoic acid has five branches that are 4, 5, 6, 7, and 8 carbons long.
  • the “longest” branch is eight carbons.
  • a preferred group of branched fatty acids are those having from three to ten carbon atoms in the longest branch.
  • acylating moieties consist of cyclic alkyl acids having from 5 to 24 carbon atoms, wherein the cyclic alkyl moiety, or moieties, have 5 to 7 carbon atoms.
  • a representative number of such cyclic alkyl acids will be mentioned to assure the reader's comprehension of the range of such acids that may be used as acylating moieties of the proteins in the present invention: cyclopentyl-formic acid, cyclohexyl-formic acid, 1-cyclopentyl-acetic acid, 2-cyclohexyl-acetic acid, 1,2-dicyclopentyl-acetic acid, and the like.
  • a preferred group of derivatized proteins for use in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of mono-acylated proteins. Mono-acylation at the ⁇ -amino group is most preferred. For insulin, mono-acylation at LysB29 is preferred. Similarly, for certain insulin analogs, such as, LysB2B, ProB29-human insulin analog, mono-acylation at the ⁇ -amino group of LysB28 is most preferred. Mono-acylation at the ⁇ -amino group of the B-chain (B1) is also preferred. Mono-acylation at the ⁇ -amino group of the A-chain (A1) is also preferred.
  • the di-acylation may be, for example, at the ⁇ -amino group of Lys and at the ⁇ -amino group of the B-chain, or may be at the ⁇ -amino group of Lys and at the ⁇ -amino group of the A-chain, or may be at the ⁇ -amino group the A-chain and at the ⁇ -amino group of the B-chain.
  • Tri-acylated proteins are those that are acylated at the ⁇ -amino group of Lys, at the ⁇ -amino group of the B-chain, and at the ⁇ -amino group of the A-chain.
  • acylated proteins that are a mixture of mono-acylated and di-acylated proteins.
  • acylated proteins that are a mixture of mono-acylated and tri-acylated proteins.
  • acylated proteins consist of a mixture of di-acylated and tri-acylated proteins.
  • acylated proteins that are a mixture of mono-acylated, di-acylated, and tri-acylated proteins.
  • A1-N ⁇ -Nonanoyl-, B1-N ⁇ -nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog [0236] A1-N ⁇ -Nonanoyl-, B1-N ⁇ -nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog.
  • A1-N ⁇ -Decanoyl-, B1-N ⁇ -decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog [0243] A1-N ⁇ -Decanoyl-, B1-N ⁇ -decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog.
  • Aqueous compositions containing water as the major solvent are preferred.
  • Aqueous suspensions wherein water is the solvent are highly preferred.
  • compositions of the present invention are used to treat patients who have diabetes or hyperglycemia.
  • the formulations of the present invention will typically provide derivatized protein at concentrations of from about 1 mg/ML to about 10 mg/mL.
  • Present formulations of insulin products are typically characterized in terms of the concentration of units of insulin activity (units/mL), such as U40, U50, U100, and so on, which correspond roughly to about 1.4, 1.75, and 3.5 mg/mL preparations, respectively.
  • a daily dose would be in the range of from about 1 nmol/kg body weight to about 6 nmol/kg body weight (6 nmol is considered equivalent to about 1 unit of insulin activity).
  • a dose of between about 2 and about 3 nmol/kg is typical of present insulin therapy.
  • compositions and formulations of the present invention may also be administered by nasal, buccal, pulmonary, or occular routes.
  • Glycerol at a concentration of 12 mg/mL to 25 mg/mL is preferred as an isotonicity agent. Yet more highly preferred for isotonicity is to use glycerol at a concentration of from about 15 mg/mL to about 17 mg/mL.
  • M-cresol and phenol, or mixtures thereof, are preferred preservatives in formulations of the present invention.
  • Insulin, insulin analogs, or proinsulins used to prepare derivatized proteins can be prepared by any of a variety of recognized peptide synthesis techniques including classical (solution) methods, solid phase methods, semi-synthetic methods, and more recent recombinant DNA methods.
  • classical (solution) methods including classical (solution) methods, solid phase methods, semi-synthetic methods, and more recent recombinant DNA methods.
  • These references are expressly incorporated herein by reference.
  • derivatized proteins are prepared using methods known in the art.
  • the publications listed above to describe derivatized proteins contain suitable methods to prepared derivatized proteins. Those publications are expressly incorporated by reference for methods of preparing derivatized proteins.
  • an activated organic acid such as an activated fatty acid.
  • Activated fatty acids are derivatives of commonly employed acylating agents, and include activated esters of fatty acids, fatty acid halides, activated amides of fatty acids, such as, activated azolide derivatives [Hansen, L. B., WIPO Publication No. 98/02460, Jan. 22, 1998], and fatty acid anhydrides.
  • activated esters especially N-hydroxysuccinimide esters of fatty acids
  • acylating a free amino acid with a fatty acid Lapidot, et al. describe the preparation of N-hydroxysuccinimide esters and their use in the preparation of N-lauroyl-glycine, N-lauroyl-L-serine, and N-lauroyl-L-glutamic acid.
  • activated fatty acid ester means a fatty acid which has been activated using general techniques known in the art [Riordan, J. F. and Vallee, B.
  • HOBT Hydroxybenzotriazide
  • N-hydroxysuccinimide N-hydroxysuccinimide and derivatives thereof are particularly well known for forming activated acids for peptide synthesis.
  • ⁇ -amino group may be used to block the ⁇ -amino groups during the coupling.
  • a suitable protecting group is known to one skilled in the art and includes p-methoxybenzoxycarbonyl (pmZ).
  • the ⁇ -amino group is acylated in a one-step synthesis without the use of amino-protecting groups.
  • a process for selective acylation at the N ⁇ -amino group of Lys is disclosed and claimed by Baker, J. C., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,646,242, Jul. 8, 1997, the entire disclosure of which is incorporated expressly by reference.
  • the primary role of zinc in the present invention is to facilitate formation of Zn(II) hexamers of the derivatized protein.
  • Zinc is known to facilitate the formation of hexamers of insulin, and of insulin analogs. Zinc likewise promotes the formation of hexamers of derivatized insulin and insulin analogs. Hexamer formation is conveniently achieved by bringing the pH of a solution comprising derivatized protein into the neutral region in the presence of Zn(II) ions, or by adding Zn(II) after the pH has been adjusted to the neutral region.
  • the ratio of zinc to derivatized protein in the microcrystal and amorphous precipitate of the present invention is bounded at the lower limit by about 0.33, that is, two zinc atoms per hexamer of derivatized protein which are needed for efficient hexamerization.
  • the microcrystal and amorphous precipitate compositions will form suitably with about 2 to about 4-6 zinc atoms present. Even more zinc may be used during the process if a compound that competes with the protein for zinc binding, such as citrate or phosphate, is present. Excess zinc above the amount needed for hexamerization may be desirable to more strongly drive hexamerization.
  • excess zinc above the amount needed for hexamerization can be present in a formulation of the present invention, and may be desirable to improve chemical and physical stability, to improve suspendability, and possibly to extend time-action further. Consequently there is a fairly wide range of zinc:protein ratios allowable in the formulations of the present invention.
  • zinc is present in the formulation in an amount of from about 0.3 mole to about 7 moles per mole of derivatized protein and more preferably about from 0.3 mole to about 1.0 mole of derivatized protein. Yet more highly preferred is a ratio of zinc to derivatized protein from about 0.3 to about 0.7 mole of zinc atoms per mole of derivatized protein. Most highly preferred is a ratio of zinc to derivatized protein from about 0.30 to about 0.55 mole of zinc atoms per mole of derivatized protein. For higher zinc formulations that are similar to PZI preparations, the zinc ratio is from about 5 to about 7 moles of zinc per mole of derivatized protein.
  • the zinc compound that provides zinc for the present invention may be any pharmaceutically acceptable zinc compound.
  • the addition of zinc to insulin preparations is known in the art, as are pharmaceutically acceptable sources of zinc.
  • Preferred zinc compounds to supply zinc for the present invention include zinc chloride, zinc acetate, zinc citrate, zinc oxide, and zinc nitrate.
  • a complexing compound is required for the microcrystals and precipitates of the present invention.
  • the complexing compound must be present in sufficient quantities to cause substantial precipitation and crystallization of hexamers of the derivatized protein. Such quantities can be readily determined for a particular preparation of a particular complexing compound by simple titration experiments.
  • the complexing compound concentration is adjusted so that there is negligible complexing compound remaining in the soluble phase after completion of precipitation and crystallization. This requires combining the complexing compound based on an experimentally determined “isophane” ratio. This ratio is expected to be very similar to that of NPh and NPL.
  • protamine When protamine is the complexing compound, it is present in the microcrystal in an amount of from about 0.15 mg to about 0.5 mg per 3.5 mg of the derivatized protein.
  • the ratio of protamine to derivatized protein is preferably from about 0.25 to about 0.40 (mg/mg). More preferably the ratio is from about 0.25 to about 0.38 (mg/mg).
  • protamine is in an amount of 0.05 mg to about 0.2 mg per mg of the derivatized protein, and more preferably, from about 0.05 to about 0.15 milligram of protamine per milligram of derivatized protein.
  • Protamine sulfate is the preferred salt form of protamine for use in the present invention.
  • compositions of the present invention may be added after crystallization.
  • additional protamine and zinc may be added after crystallization.
  • formulations having protamine at higher than isophane ratios are also within the present invention.
  • the protamine ratio is from 0.25 mg to about 0.5 mg of protamine per mg of derivatized protein.
  • a required component of the microcrystals and precipitates of the present invention is a hexamer stabilizing compound.
  • the structures of three hexameric conformations have been characterized in the literature, and are designated T6, T3R3, and R6.
  • hexamer stabilizing compound such as various phenolic compounds
  • the R6 conformation is stabilized. Therefore, it is highly likely that hexamers are in the R6 conformation, or the T3R3 conformation in the crystals and precipitates produced in the presence of a hexamer stabilizing compound, such as phenol.
  • a wide range of hexamer stabilizing compounds are suitable.
  • At least 2 moles of hexamer stabilizing compound per hexamer of derivatized protein are required for effective hexamer stabilization. It is preferred that at least 3 moles of hexamer stabilizing compound per hexamer of derivatized protein be present in the microcrystals and precipitates of the present invention.
  • the presence of higher ratios of hexamer stabilizing compound, at least up to 25 to 50-fold higher, in the solution from which the microcrystals and precipitates are prepared will not adversely affect hexamer stabilization.
  • a preservative may be present, especially if the formulation is intended to be sampled from multiple times.
  • a wide range of suitable preservatives are known.
  • the preservative is present in the solution in an amount suitable to provide an antimicrobial effect sufficient to meet pharmacopoeial requirements.
  • Preferred preservatives are the phenolic preservatives, which are enumerated above. Preferred concentrations for the phenolic preservative are from about 2 mg to about 5 mg per milliliter of the aqueous suspension formulation. These concentrations refer to the total mass of phenolic preservatives because mixtures of individual phenolic preservatives are contemplated. Suitable phenolic preservatives include, for example, phenol, m-cresol, and methylparaben. Preferred phenolic compounds are phenol and m-cresol. Mixtures of phenolic compounds, such as phenol and m-cresol, are also contemplated and highly preferred. Examples of mixtures of phenolic compounds are 0.6 mg/mL phenol and 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, and 0.7 mg/mL phenol and 1.8 mg/mL m-cresol.
  • the microcrystals of the present invention are preferably oblong-shaped, single crystals composed of derivatized protein complexed with a divalent cation, and including a complexing compound and a hexamer-stabilizing compound.
  • the mean length of the microcrystals of the present invention preferably is within the range of 1 micron to 40 microns, and more preferably is within the size range of 3 microns to 15 microns.
  • a preferred composition comprises from about 3 mg to about 6 mg of protamine sulfate per 35 mg of derivatized protein, and from about 0.1 to about 0.4 mg zinc per 35 mg of derivatized protein.
  • Another preferred composition comprises from about 10 mg to about 17 mg of protamine sulfate per 35 mg of derivatized protein, and from about 2.0 to about 2.5 mg zinc per 35 mg of derivatized protein.
  • Another preferred composition comprises, per mL, protamine sulfate, 0.34-0.38 mg; zinc, 0.01-0.04 mg; and derivatized protein, 3.2-3.8 mg.
  • amorphous precipitates and crystals of the present invention can be prepared for use in medicaments, or other used, by many different processes.
  • suitable processes will generally follow the sequence: solubilization, hexamerization, complexation, precipitation, crystallization, and optionally formulation.
  • Solubilization means the dissolution of derivatized protein sufficiently to allow it to form hexamers.
  • Hexamerization refers to the process wherein molecules of derivatized protein bind with zinc(II) atoms to form hexamers.
  • Complexation denotes the formation of insoluble complexes between the hexamers and protamine. Precipitation results typically from the formation of insoluble complexes. Crystallization involves the conversion of precipitated hexamer/protamine complexes into crystals, typically, rod-like crystals.
  • Solubilization is carried out by dissolving the derivatized protein in an aqueous solvent.
  • the aqueous solvent may be, for example, an acidic solution, a neutral solution, or a basic solution.
  • the aqueous solvent may be comprised partially of a miscible organic solvent, such as ethanol, acetonitrile, dimethylsulfoxide, and the like.
  • Acidic solutions may be, for example, solutions of HCl, advantageously from about 0.01 N HCl to about 1.0 N HCl. Other acids that are pharmaceutically acceptable may be employed as well.
  • Basic solutions may be, for example, solutions of NaOH, advantageously from about 0.01 N NaOH to about 1.0 N NaOH, or higher.
  • Other bases that are pharmaceutically acceptable may be employed as well.
  • the concentration of acid or base is preferably as low as possible while still being effective to adequately dissolve the derivatized protein.
  • solutions to dissolve derivatized proteins at neutral pH may contain a buffer and optionally, salts, a phenolic compound or compounds, zinc, or an isotonicity agent.
  • the solution conditions required for hexamerization are those that allow the formation of derivatized protein-zinc hexamers in solution.
  • hexamerization requires zinc and neutral pH.
  • the presence of a hexamer-stabilizing compound advantageously influences the conformation of the derivatized protein in the hexamer, and promotes the R6 or the T3R3 hexamer conformations.
  • the complexation step must involve the combination of protamine with hexamer under solution conditions where each is initially soluble. This could be accomplished by combining separate solutions of hexameric derivatized protein and of protamine, or by forming a solution of derivatized protein and protamine at acidic or basic pH, and then shifting the pH to the neutral range.
  • the solution conditions must stabilize the crystallizing species.
  • the solution conditions will determine the rate and outcome of the crystallization.
  • Crystallization likely occurs through an equilibrium involving non-crystalline precipitated derivatized-protamine complexes, dissolved derivatized protein-protamine complex, and crystallized derivatized protein-protamine.
  • the conditions chosen for crystallization drive the equilibrium toward crystal formation.
  • the solubility of the derivatized protein is expected to profoundly affect rate and size because a lower solubility will slow the net conversion from precipitate to solution to crystal.
  • it is well-recognized that slowing the rate of crystallization often results in larger crystals.
  • the crystallization rate and crystal size are thought to depend on the size and nature of the derivatizing moiety on the derivatized protein.
  • Crystallization parameters that influence the crystallization rate and the size of crystals of the present invention are: acyl group size and nature; temperature; the presence and concentration of compounds that compete with derivatized protein for zinc, such as citrate, phosphate, and the like; the nature and concentration of phenolic compound(s); zinc concentration; the presence and concentration of a miscible organic solvent; the time permitted for crystallization; the pH and ionic strength; buffer identity and concentration; the concentration of precipitants; the presence of seeding materials; the shape and material of the container; the stirring rate; and the total protein concentration. Temperature and the concentration of competing compounds are thought to be of particular importance.
  • Competing compounds affect the rate at which crystals form, and indirectly, crystal size and quality. These compounds may exert their effect by forming coordination complexes with zinc in solution, thus competing with the relatively weak zinc binding sites on the surface of derivatized protein hexamer for zinc. Occupation of these weak surface binding sites probably impedes crystallization. Additionally, many derivatized proteins are partially insoluble in the presence of little more than 0.333 zinc per mole of derivatized protein, and the presence of competing compounds restores solubility, and permits crystallization. The exact concentration of competing compound will need to be optimized for each derivatized protein. As an upper limit, of course, is the concentration at which zinc is precipitated by the competing compound, or the concentration at which residual competing compound would be pharmaceutically unacceptable, such as, when it would cause pain or irritation at the site of administration.
  • An example of a process for preparing the precipitates and crystals of the present invention follows.
  • a measured amount of a powder of the derivatized protein is dissolved in an aqueous solvent containing a phenolic preservative.
  • a solution of zinc as one of its soluble salts for example Zn(II)Cl 2
  • Absolute ethanol, or another miscible organic solvent may optionally be added to this solution in an amount to make the solution from about 5% to about 10% by volume organic solvent.
  • This solution may then be filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution is prepared by dissolving a measured amount of protamine in water equal to one tenth the concentration by weight of the aforementioned derivatized insulin solution. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • the derivatized insulin solution and the protamine solutions are combined in equal volumes, and the resulting solution is then stirred slowly at room temperature (typically about 20-25° C.) whereupon the microcrystals of the derivatized protein are formed within a period from about 12 hours to about 10 days.
  • the microcrystals may then be separated from the mother liquor and introduced into a different solvent, for storage and administration to a patient.
  • aqueous solvents are as follows: water for injection containing 25 mM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol and 16 mg/ML glycerol; water for injection containing 2 mg/mL sodium phosphate dibasic, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol; and water for injection containing 25 mM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 16 mg/ML glycerol.
  • the crystals are prepared in a manner that obviates the need to separate the crystals from the mother liquor.
  • the mother liquor itself be suitable for administration to the patient, or that the mother liquor can be made suitable for administration by dilution with a suitable diluent.
  • diluent will be understood to mean a solution comprised of an aqueous solvent in which is dissolved various pharmaceutically acceptable excipients, including without limitation, a buffer, an isotonicity agent, zinc, a preservative, protamine, and the like.
  • compositions adapted for parenteral administration in accordance with the present invention may employ additional excipients and carriers such as water miscible organic solvents such as glycerol, sesame oil, aqueous propylene glycol and the like. When present, such agents are usually used in an amount ranging from about 0.5% to about 2.0% by weight based upon the final formulation.
  • additional excipients and carriers such as water miscible organic solvents such as glycerol, sesame oil, aqueous propylene glycol and the like.
  • such agents are usually used in an amount ranging from about 0.5% to about 2.0% by weight based upon the final formulation.
  • examples of such pharmaceutical compositions include sterile, isotonic, aqueous saline solutions of the derivatized insulin derivative buffered with a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer and pyrogen free.
  • a formulation may contain a mixture of the microcrystalline formulation and a soluble fraction of the derivatized insulin or a soluble fraction of normal insulin or rapid-acting insulin analog, such as, LysB28, ProB29-human insulin.
  • Such mixtures are designed to provide a combination of meal-time control of glucose levels, which is provided by the soluble insulin, and basal control of glucose levels, which is provided by the insoluble insulin.
  • the yield of precipitates and crystals was estimated.
  • the yield estimate relied on determination of the amount of derivatized insulin or derivatized insulin analog in the precipitate or crystal, and on an estimate of the amount of the same initially in solution.
  • samples of re-dissolved precipitate or crystal, and of the supernatant above the precipitate or crystals were analyzed by reversed-phase gradient HPLC, as described below.
  • HPLC HPLC was used to confirm the presence of the expected proteins in the acidified suspension, re-dissolved precipitate, and supernatant and also to determine protein concentrations.
  • the retention times of peaks in the chromatograms of the re-dissolved precipitates were compared with the retention times observed for protamine and the insulin compounds used to make the formulations. The agreement between retention times was always good, showing that the protamine and the derivatized proteins used to make the formulations were actually incorporated in the crystals.
  • Concentrations of derivatized proteins were determined by comparing the appropriate peak areas to the areas of a standard. Protamine concentrations were not quantitated. A 0.22 mg/mL solution of derivatized insulin was used as the standard. A standard containing protamine was run, but only for the purpose of determining the retention time. Protamine concentration was not quantitated.
  • a standard spectrophotometric assay was used to determine how rapidly the crystals dissolved in Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (pH 7.4) at room temperature. Significant deviations from the procedure described immediately below are noted where appropriate in the descriptions of the preparations.
  • a spectrophotometer suitable for measuring in the ultraviolet range, and equipped with a 1 cm cuvette and a magnetic cuvette stirrer was used for all the dissolution assays. The cuvette, containing a small stir bar and 3.00 mL of phosphate buffered saline (PBS), was put into the cell compartment of the spectrophotometer. The instrument was set to 320 nm and zeroed against the same buffer.
  • U100 Humulin® N i.e., human insulin NPH, which is also known as human NPH insulin
  • PBS buffer 3.00 mL
  • the dissolution half-time time (t1 ⁇ 2) for the Humulin® N formulation was about 6 minutes.
  • Gly(A21)Arg(B31)Arg(B32)-human insulin was obtained from an E. coli fermentation in which a Gly(A21)-human proinsulin precursor molecule was overexpressed into inclusion bodies.
  • a portion (94.7 g) of inclusion bodies was solubilized in 500 mL of 6 M guanidine hydrochloride containing 0.1 M TRIS, 0.27 M sodium sulfite, and 0.1 M sodium tetrathionate, pH 10.5 at room temperature. The pH was quickly lowered to 8.8 with 12 N HCl. After vigorously stirring in an open container for 45 minutes the pH was lowered to 2.1 with phosphoric acid and the sample centrifuged overnight at 4° C.
  • the supernatant was decanted and stored at 4° C for additional processing.
  • the pellet was re-extracted with 200 mL of additional pH 10.5 solution (see above) and then centrifuged for 3 hours at 4° C.
  • This and the previously obtained supernatant were each diluted 4 ⁇ with 100 mM sodium phosphate, pH 4, precipitating the product and other acidic components. After allowing the precipitate to settle, most of the supernatant was decanted and discarded.
  • the resulting suspension was centrifuged, followed by decanting and discarding of additional supernatant, leaving wet pellets of the crude Gly(A21)-human proinsulin S-sulfonate precursor.
  • the pellets were solubilized in 1.5 liters of 7 M deionized urea, adjusting the pH to 8 with 5 N NaOH and stirring over several hours at 4° C. Salt (NaCl) was then added to achieve 1 M concentration and the sample was loaded onto a XAD-7 column (14 cm ⁇ 20 cm, Toso-Haas, Montgomeryville, Pa.), previously flushed with 50% acetonitrile/50% 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, 10% acetonitrile/90% 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, and finally with 7 M deionized urea/1M NaCl/20 mm TRIS, pH 8.
  • Salt NaCl
  • the column was pumped with 4.5 liters of a 7 M deionized urea/1 M NaCl/20 mM TRIS, pH 8 solution, followed by 2.8 liters of 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate/1 M NaCl, and 6.5 liters of 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate.
  • the column was eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, while monitoring the eluant by UW at 280 nm.
  • the peak of interest, partially purified Gly(A21)-human proinsulin S-sulfonate precursor was collected, lyophilized, and subjected to a folding/disulfide bond procedure as follows.
  • a quantity (5.4 g) of the precursor was dissolved in 3 liters of 20 mM glycine, pH 10.5, 4° C. Then, 15 mL of 240 mm cysteine HCl were added with stirring, while maintaining the pH at 10.5 and the temperature at 4° C. The reaction solution was stirred gently at 4° C. for 27 hours and then quenched by lowering the pH to 3.1 with phosphoric acid. Acetonitrile (155 ML) was added, and the solution was then loaded onto a 5 ⁇ 25 cm C4 reversed-phase column previously pumped with 60% acetonitrile/40% water/0.1% TFA and equilibrated in 10% acetonitrile/90% water/0.1% TFA.
  • the column was pumped with 1 liter of 17.5% acetonitrile/82.5% water/0.1% TFA, then eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 0.1% TFA while monitoring at 280 nm. Selected fractions were pooled and lyophilized with a recovery of 714 mg.
  • 697 mg of the Gly(A21) human proinsulin precursor were dissolved in 70 mL 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, then chilled to 4°C., pH 8.3.
  • a volume (0.14 mL) of a 1 mg/mL solution of pork trypsin (Sigma Chemical Company, St.
  • the quenched Gly(A21)Arg(B31)Arg(B32)-human insulin sample solution from the tryptic cleavage reaction was diluted 4 ⁇ with 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid, pH 3.1, and loaded onto a 1 ⁇ 30 cm S HyperD F (Biosepra, Marlborough, Mass.) cation exchange column previously pumped with 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid/500 mM NaCl, pH 3.3, and equilibrated in 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid.
  • HyperD F Biosepra, Marlborough, Mass.
  • the column was pumped with about 50 mL of 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid, then eluted with a linear gradient of NaCl in 30% acetonitrile/50 mM acetic acid while monitoring the eluant at 276 nm.
  • Selected fractions containing the Gly(A21)Arg(B31)Arg(B32)-human insulin were pooled, diluted 3 ⁇ with purified water and loaded onto a 2.2 ⁇ 25 cm C4 reversed-phase column (Vydac, Hesperia, Calif.) previously pumped with 60% acetonitrile/40% water/0.1% TFA, then 10% acetonitrile/90% water/0.1% TFA.
  • the column was pumped with about 200 mL of 10% acetonitrile/90% water/0.1% TFA, then eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 0.1% TFA. Selected fractions were pooled and lyophilized giving a recovery of 101 mg.
  • Analytical HPLC revealed a purity of greater that 95% main peak.
  • Des(B30)-human insulin was prepared from human proinsulin by controlled tryptic hydrolysis.
  • a mass (2 g) of human proinsulin biosynthesized in recombinant E. coli and purified by conventional methods [Frank, B. H., et al., in PEPTIDES: Synthesis - Structure - Function. Proceedings of the Seventh American Peptide Symposium, Rich, D. H. and Gross, E. (Eds.), Pierce Chemical Company, Rockford, pp. 729-738, 1981; also, Frank, B. H., U.S. Pat. No. 4,430,266, issued Feb.
  • the solution was brought to room temperature and diluted with 50 mL acetonitrile, then to a final volume of 500 mL with purified water, then loaded onto a 2.5 ⁇ 58 cm CG-161 (Toso-Haas) column previously pumped with 1 c.v. (column volume) of 40% acetonitrile/60% 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5, and 2 c.v. of 10% acetonitrile/90% 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5. Once loaded the column was pumped with 1 c.v. of 10% acetonitrile/90% 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5.
  • the column was eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5, while monitoring the eluant at 276 nm.
  • the peak of interest, partially purified des(B30)-human insulin was collected by pooling selected fractions. This pooled sample of partially purified des(B30)-human insulin was diluted to 1.28 liters with purified water, pH 3.5, and applied to a 1 ⁇ 29 cm S HyperD F (Biosepra) cation exchange column previously pumped with 1 c.v. of 30% acetonitrile/70% 0.1% TFA/0.5 M NaCl, pH 1.9, and 2 c.v.
  • Rabbit insulin was prepared as described in Chance, R. E., et al. [Proinsulin, Insulin, C-Peptide, Baba, S., et al. (Eds.), Excerpta Medica, Amsterdam-Oxford, pp. 99-105 (1979)].
  • Asp(B28)-human insulin was prepared and purified essentially according to the teaching of examples 31 and 32 of Chance, R. B., et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 5,700,662, issued Dec. 23, 1997) which is expressly incorporated herein by reference. Des(B23-30)-human insulin [Bromer, W. W. and Chance, R. B., Biochim. Biophys.
  • a measured mass of purified insulin or of an insulin analog was dissolved in a measured volume of dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) with stirring. Then, a measured volume of tetramethylguanidine hydrochloride (TMG) was added and the solution mixed thoroughly. In a separate container, a measured mass of an N-acyl-succinimide (NAB) was dissolved in a measured volume of DMSO. A measured volume of the second solution was added to the first solution. The reaction was carried out at room temperature, and the progress of the reaction was monitored by analyzing samples of the reaction mixture using HPLC. The reaction was quenched by adding a measured volume of ethanolamine, and then acidifying to pH 2-3.
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • TMG tetramethylguanidine hydrochloride
  • NAB N-acyl-succinimide
  • reaction mixture was then subjected to purification using reversed-phase chromatography alone, or using a combination of cation exchange chromatography followed by reversed-phase chromatography.
  • the reversed-phase purification was carried out using an FPLC® system (Pharmacia) with UV detection at 214 nm or at 280 nm, a fraction collector, 2.2 ⁇ 25 cm or 5 ⁇ 30 cm C18 column, 2.5 or 5 mL/min flow rate, at room temperature.
  • the liquid phases were mixtures of Solution A [0.1% trifluroacetic acid (TFA) in 10:90 acetonitrile:water (vol:vol)] and Solution B [0.1% trifluroacetic acid (TFA) in 70:30 acetonitrile:water (vol:vol)] appropriate to elute and separate the species of interest.
  • Solution A 0.1% trifluroacetic acid (TFA) in 10:90 acetonitrile:water (vol:vol)
  • Solution B 0.1% trifluroacetic acid (TFA) in 70:30 acetonitrile:water (vol:vol)
  • Table 2 below provides experimental data, according to the outline above, for the synthesis of the derivatized proteins that were used to prepare various embodiments of the present invention.
  • the starting proteins were prepared as described above, or according to conventional methods.
  • Conventional purification was used to provide highly purified starting proteins for the syntheses described below.
  • the synthesis of insulin, insulin analogs, and proinsulin is within the skill of the art, and may be accomplished using recombinant expression, semisythesis, or solid phase synthesis followed by chain combination.
  • the purification of synthesized proteins to a purity adequate to prepare the derivatives used in the present invention is carried out by conventional purification techniques.
  • a measured mass of purified insulin or of an insulin analog was dissolved by adding to it a measured volume of 50 mM boric acid, pH 2.57.
  • the “solvent” volume is the sum of the volumes of the boric acid and acetonitrile.
  • the pH of the solution was adjusted to between 10.2 and 10.5 using NaOH.
  • NAS N-acyl-succinimide
  • a measured volume of the second solution was added to the first solution.
  • the reaction was carried out at room temperature, the pH was maintained above 10.2 as necessary, and the progress of the reaction was monitored by analyzing samples of the reaction mixture using HPLC.
  • the reaction was quenched by acidifying to pH 2-3.
  • the reaction mixture was then subjected to purification using a reversed-phase chromatography system as described above.
  • Table 3 provides experimental data, according to the outline above, for the synthesis of the derivatized proteins that were used to prepare various embodiments of the present invention. Molecular weight of the purified derivatives was confirmed by mass spectrometry via electrospray mass analysis (ESMS). Assignment of the acylation site was based either on a chromatographic analysis (“HPLC”), or on an N-terminal analysis (“N-terminal”), or both. TABLE 3 Summary of synthesis of various derivatized proteins.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB29 human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • To this solution is added 150 parts of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride. The pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH. Then 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is stirred slowly for 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.). The amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid.
  • microcrystals prepared by the method of Preparation 6 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods, such as, filtration, centrifugation, or decantation.
  • the recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 25 mM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 7.4, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds to the equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-LysB29 human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 MM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, 10 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol at pH 7.6.
  • an aqueous solvent composed of 25 MM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, 10 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol at pH 7.6.
  • the pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH.
  • 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is stirred slowly for 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.). The amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid.
  • microcrystals prepared by the method of Preparation 8 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods.
  • the recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 2 mg/mL sodium phosphate dibasic, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 6.8, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds approximately to the concentration equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin.
  • a dry powder of B28-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB28-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • To this solution is added 150 parts of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride. The pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH. Then 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. After 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.), the amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid.
  • microcrystals prepared by the method of Preparation 10 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods.
  • the recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 25 MM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 7.6, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds approximately to the concentration equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -butyryl-LysB29 human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • To this solution is added 150 parts of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride. The pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH. Then 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. After 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.), the amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid.
  • microcrystals prepared by the method of Preparation 7 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods.
  • the recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 25 mM TRIS, 2.5 mg/mL m-cresol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 7.8, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds approximately to the concentration equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin.
  • B29-N ⁇ -butyryl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -butyryl-human insulin (16.21 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of acrystallization diluent was added, and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed.
  • the crystallization diluent was prepared by dissolving in water, with stirring, 0.603 g of TRIS, 1.007 g of phenol, 1.582 g of glycerol and 2.947 g of trisodium citrate. Further water was added to bring the of the solution to 100 mL. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the crystallization diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.59 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • B29-N ⁇ -pentanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -pentanoyl-human insulin (16.14 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • the procedure described in Preparation 14 was followed, except the pH was adjusted to 7.60, and the protamine solution contained 18.64 mg of protamine sulfate in a total volume of 50 mL.
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -pentanoyl-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 33-34 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl human insulin (15.87 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • the procedure described in Preparation 14 was followed, except the pH was adjusted to 7.58.
  • Rod-like crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%).
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 69-70 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -(2-methylhexanoyl)-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5. A mass (8.19 mg) of B29-N ⁇ -(2-methylhexanoyl)-human insulin was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed thoroughly. Then, 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate) was added and mixed.
  • diluent in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -2-methylhexanoyl-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 23 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB29 human insulin (4.17 mg) was dissolved in 1 mL of a solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • a solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6.
  • 0.15 mL of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride was added.
  • the resulting solution was adjusted to a pH of 7.6 with 1 N NaOH.
  • 0.12 mL of ethanol was added.
  • the resulting solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution was prepared by dissolving 3.23 mg of protamine sulfate in 10 mL of water then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a volume 1 mL of the 329-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB29 human insulin solution and 1 mL of the protamine sulfate solution were combined, resulting in the immediate appearance of an amorphous precipitate.
  • This solution was divided into two 1 mL portions which were transferred to vials then gently agitated for 19 hours at room temperature (approximately 22° C.), using an automatic wrist-action shaker. This procedure resulted in the formation of a white-to-off-white microcrystalline solid. HPLC analysis of crystals that have been removed from the mother liquor and thoroughly washed demonstrated the presence of protamine within the crystalline material.
  • N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin was prepared by dissolving 39.7 mg of N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin in 1 mL of 0.1 N HCl. This solution was stirred for approximately 5 minutes. To this solution was added 0.4 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) with stirring. The zinc nitrate solution was 1:10 dilution of a 10,000 ppm Zn(II) atomic absorption standard.
  • N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin plus zinc solution was added 4 mL of a crystallization diluent (40 mg/ml glycerol, 50 mM TRIS, 4 mg/mL m-cresol, 1.625 mg/mL phenol, 100 mM trisodium citrate, pH 7.4).
  • the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.61.
  • the pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low protein-binding filter.
  • protamine solution 37.6 mg of protamine sulfate in 50 mL of water
  • the solution was allowed to stand undisturbed for 63 hours at a controlled temperature of 25° C.
  • the crystals were sedimented by allowing the formulation to stand undisturbed. Eight milliliters (8 mL) of the supernatant were then removed, and were replaced with 8 mL of a diluent [16 mg/mL glycerol, 20 mM TRIS, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, 40 mM trisodium citrate, pH 7.4]. The crystals were then resuspended. This procedure was carried out in the same way three times, except that on the third occasion, the 8 mL of supernatant was replaced with 7 mL of diluent.
  • the amount of insulins in the formulation was analyzed by HPLC to quantitate the total potency.
  • the total potency refers to the total concentration of human insulin and N ⁇ -hexanoyl-human insulin.
  • An aliquot (0.050 mL) of the fully resuspended formulation was dissolved in 0.950 mL of 0.01 N HCL, and subjected to HPLC analysis, as described below.
  • a solution of 1.000 mg/mL of human insulin in a 1 cm cuvette was assumed to have an absorbance of 1.05 optical density units at the wavelength maximum (approximately 276 nm). This corresponds to a molar extinction coefficient of 6098.
  • Acylated insulins were assumed to have the same molar extinction coefficient as human insulin.
  • the solutions calibrated by UV were then diluted to get standards at 0.220, 0.147, 0.073, and 0.022 mg/mL.
  • the standards were run on HPLC and a standard curve of area vs. concentration was obtained.
  • the dissolution rate of the crystals was measured by placing 0.005 mL of the uniformly suspended formulation into 3 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium or magnesium) in a 1 cm path length square quartz cuvette at a temperature of 22° C. This solution was stirred at a constant rate using a magnetic cuvette stirrer. Absorbance measurements at 320 nm were taken at 1 minute intervals. The absorbance at 320 nm corresponds to the light scattered by the insoluble particles present in the aqueous suspension. Consequently, as the microcrystals dissolve, the absorbance approaches zero. The approximate time required for the 0.005 mL of this formulation to dissolve was more than 400 minutes. The time required for a 0.005 mL sample of U100 commercial Humulin® N to dissolve under the same conditions was about 10 minutes.
  • Particle size measurement was performed on a sample of the formulation utilizing a particle sizing instrument (Multisizer Model IIE, Coulter Corp., Miami, Fla., 33116-9015). To perform this measurement, 0.25 mL of the crystal formulation was added to 100 mL of a diluent consisting 14 mM dibasic sodium phosphate, 16 mM glycerol, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, pH 7.4. The instrument aperture tube orifice size was 50 microns. Particle size data were collected for 50 seconds.
  • a particle sizing instrument Multisizer Model IIE, Coulter Corp., Miami, Fla., 33116-9015.
  • the mean particle diameter of the crystals was approximately 6 microns, with an approximately normal distribution, encompassing a range of particle sizes from approximately 2 &microns to approximately 12 microns. This result is similar to the particle size distribution of commercial NPH as reported in DeFelippis, M. R., et al., J. Pharmaceut. Sci. 87:170-176 (1998).
  • N ⁇ -nonanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of N ⁇ -nonanoyl-human insulin (16.16 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • the procedure described in Preparation 14 was followed, except the protamine solution contained 18.64 mg of protamine sulfate in a total volume of 50 mL.
  • Rod-like crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%).
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -nonanoyl-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 83 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -decanoyl-human insulin was prepared essentially as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -decanoyl-human insulin (60.7 mg) was dissolved in 1.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • a volume (0.6 ml) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and mixed thoroughly.
  • To 0.7 mL of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 2.0 mL of diluent “A” (50 MM citrate, 5 mg/mL phenol, 16 mg/mL glycerol, 25 MM TRIS, pH 7.6).
  • diluent ° “B” 100 mM citrate, 2 mg/mL phenol, 50 mM TRIS, pH 7.6.
  • the pH in the vials was adjusted to 7.62 and 7.61, respectively, and each was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a volume of the contents of vial A (2.5 mL) was mixed with 2.5 mL of a protamine sulfate solution (7.4 mg protamine sulfate dissolved in 10 mL of diluent A).
  • a cloudy precipitate developed immediately. The preparation was allowed to stand undisturbed at 25° C.
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -decanoyl-human insulin in vial B had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 70 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -dodecanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -dodecanoyl-human insulin (17.00 mg) was dissolved in 4.0 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 8.47).
  • the pH of the solution of the insulin analog derivative was adjusted to 8.57 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH.
  • To the pH-adjusted solution was added 0.320 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II).
  • the pH of the zinc-insulin analog derivative solution was adjusted to 7.59 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH.
  • the pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • To 2.0 mL of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 0.25 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently.
  • To another 2.0 mL volume of the resulting solution in “Vial B” was added 0.6 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently.
  • To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 2.0 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL).
  • each vial contained a cloudy suspension.
  • Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Small, irregular crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%).
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -dodecanoyl-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -tetradecanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -tetradecanoyl-human insulin (16.42 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • B29-N ⁇ -hexadecanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -hexadecanoyl-human insulin (16.29 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -hexadecanoyl-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • a mass (8.13 mg) of A1-N ⁇ -octanoyl-B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin analog was dissolved in 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL; 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate).
  • the pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.61 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH.
  • 0.160 ml of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed again thoroughly.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-Gly(A21), Arg(B31), Arg(B32)-human insulin analog was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a mass (8.6 mg) of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-Gly(A21), Arg(B31), Arg(B32)-human insulin analog was dissolved in 0.4 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed again thoroughly.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-des(ThrB30) -human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin (16.21 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin (8.09 mg) was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • a volume (0.16 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(XI) was added and the resulting solution was mixed thoroughly.
  • B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-beef insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5. A sample of B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-beef insulin (16.14 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • ppm parts-per-million
  • B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-sheep insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-sheep insulin (16.15 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • the solution was hazy, and the addition of 0.1 mL 0.1 N HCl did not cause the haze to disperse completely.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-pork insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-pork insulin (16.78 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-pork insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-rabbit insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5. A sample of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-rabbit insulin (8.10 mg) was dissolved in 0.25 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.16 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring.
  • ppm parts-per-million
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-rabbit insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 119 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-des(B27)-human insulin analog was prepared as described in Preparation 5. A mass (8.02 mg) of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-des(B27)-human insulin analog was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed thoroughly.
  • ppm parts-per-million
  • a mass (8.16 mg) of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-Asp(B28)-human Insulin analog was dissolved in 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate). The pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.61 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed again thoroughly.
  • ppm parts-per-million
  • B28-N ⁇ -butryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B28-N ⁇ -butryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.09 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of crystallization diluent was added, and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed.
  • the crystallization diluent was prepared by dissolving in water, with stirring, 0.603 g of TRIS, 1.007 g of phenol, 1.582 g of glycerol and 2.947 g of trisodium citrate. Further water was added to bring the of the solution to 100 mL.) After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the crystallization diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.60 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • an aqueous solution of protamine prepared by dissolving 18.64 mg of protamine sulfate in water to a final volume of 50 mL.
  • the mixture of the two volumes was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C.
  • B28-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B28-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (15.95 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • the procedure of Preparation 38 was subsequently followed. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%).
  • the crystals of B28-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 5-6 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B28-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B28-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.8 mg) was dissolved in 4.0 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 7.58).
  • the pH of the solution of the insulin analog derivative was adjusted to 8.4 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH.
  • Vial A and Vial B To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 2.0 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, each vial contained a cloudy suspension. Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Crystals formed in both vials. The composition of the solution in Vial A was analyzed for the remaining concentration of insulin analog derivative, and the crystals were subjected to dissolution testing.
  • a protamine solution containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL.
  • B28-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B28-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.02 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • Preparation 38 was followed essentially. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%).
  • B28-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B28-N ⁇ -octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.35 mg) was dissolved in 4.0 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 7.58).
  • the pH of the solution of the insulin analog derivative was adjusted to 8.4 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH.
  • Vial A and Vial B To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 2.0 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, each vial contained a cloudy suspension. Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Crystals formed in both vials. The composition of the solution in Vial A was analyzed for the remaining concentration of insulin analog derivative, and the crystals were subjected to dissolution testing. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%).
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-rabbit insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 15 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5. A sample of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin (20.31 mg of solid, containing 16.95 mg protein) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, followed by 2.0 rnL of a diluent containing per mL: 1.625 mg phenol, 4 mg m-cresol, 40 mg glycerol, 5 mg anhydrous sodium dibasic phosphate, and 7.5 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, with a final pH of 7.6.
  • the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.58 with 0.090 mL of 1 N NaOH.
  • the solution was then passed through a 0.22 micron, low-protein-binding sterile filter, and refrigerated overnight.
  • the concentration of the insulin derivative was 6.074 mg/mL.
  • a volume of the solution (2.50 mL) was mixed with 2.875 mL of a protamine sulfate solution containing per mL 0.75 mg of solid protamine sulfate in water, and an amorphous precipitate immediately formed.
  • the concentration of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin was 2.825 mg/mL after adding protamine.
  • the suspension was injected into two dogs approximately 1 hour and forty minutes after mixing the insulin derivative with protamine.
  • B28-N ⁇ -myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared essentially as described in Preparation 5.
  • a sample of B28-N ⁇ -myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (20.43 mg of solid, 18.53 mg of protein) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl.
  • 200 microliters of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) and 2.0 mL of formulation diluent were added.
  • the formulation diluent contained, per mL: 1.6 mg phenol, 4 mg m-cresol, 40 mg glycerol, 5 mg anhydrous sodium dibasic phosphate, and 7.5 mg trisodium phosphate dihydrate, with a final pH of 7.6.
  • the pH of the formulation was adjusted from 5.9 to 8.7 with 100 microliters of 1 N NaOH.
  • the formulation was clear.
  • the pH was then reduced to 7.59 by adding 20 microliters of 1 N HCl. At this point, the protein concentration was 6.57 mg/mL.
  • the solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding sterile filter and refrigerated overnight. The next morning, the formulation had no visible precipitate present.
  • the concentration of B28-N ⁇ -myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin in the supernatant was found to be 0.005 mg/mL, and in a sample of the precipitate re-dissolved to the original volume, the concentration was 3.13 mg/mL.
  • the concentration of B28-N ⁇ -myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin in a sample of acidified suspension was 3.34 mg/mL.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 175 parts by volume of 0.1 N HCl, and then a solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mm concentration of zinc) is added.
  • a solution of zinc chloride 60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mm concentration of zinc
  • 800 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent comprising 25 mM TRIS, 10 mg/mL phenol, 0.1 M citrate, 40 mg/mL glycerol, in water at pH value 7.6.
  • the resulting solution is adjusted to pH value of 7.6, and then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • An additional solution is prepared by dissolving 7 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water.
  • the protamine solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • Equal volumes of the derivatized protein solution and the protamine solution are combined by adding the protamine solution to the acylated insulin solution.
  • An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 48 hours at a temperature of 25° C.
  • the microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 175 parts by volume of 0.1 N HCl, and then a solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc) is added.
  • a solution of zinc chloride 60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc
  • 1000 parts by mass of an aqueous solvent comprising 35 mM sodium phosphate dibasic, 4 mg/mL m-cresol, 1.6 mg/mL phenol, 25 mM citrate, and 40 mg/mL glycerol, in water, pH 7.6.
  • the resulting solution is adjusted to pH 7.6, and then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • An additional solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the derivatized insulin solution and the protamine solution are combined by adding the protamine solution to the acylated protein solution. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 1 week at a temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 175 parts by volume of 0.1 N HCl, and then a solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc) is added.
  • a solution of zinc chloride 60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc
  • 1000 parts by mass of a solvent comprising 35 mM sodium phosphate dibasic, 4 mg/mL m-cresol, 1.6 mg/mL phenol, 10 mm citrate, 40 mg/mL glycerol, in water, pH 7.6.
  • the resulting solution is adjusted to pH 7.6, and then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • An additional solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and the protamine solution are combined by adding the protamine solution to the acylated insulin solution. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 1 week at a temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin.
  • Preparation 47 The process of Preparation 47 is followed.
  • the suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 60 hours at a temperature of 30° C.
  • the microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin,
  • a solution is prepared by adding to water for injection (WFI, 1000 parts by volume): phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass). Protamine sulfate powder (0.6 parts by mass) is then dissolved in this solution.
  • a solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume) prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc in 0.1 N HCl is then added.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is added and dissolved with stirring.
  • the pH is adjusted to about 3 to aid dissolution if necessary with small quantities of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH.
  • the pH is then adjusted to within the range 3-3.6 with small quantities of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH.
  • This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution is prepared by dissolving sodium phosphate dibasic (7.56 parts by mass), phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass) in water for injection (1000 parts by volume).
  • the pH of this solution is adjusted to a value such that combination of a volume of this solution with an equal volume of the B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin solution results in a pH value of about 7.5 to about 7.7.
  • After appropriately adjusting the pH of this buffer solution it is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the buffer solution and the B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin solution are combined.
  • An amorphous precipitate forms immediately which becomes crystalline upon standing for 60 hours undisturbed at a controlled temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin.
  • a solution is prepared by adding to water for injection (1000 parts by volume) sodium phosphate dibasic (3.78 parts by mass), phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass).
  • a solution of zinc chloride (6 parts by volume) prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 153 mM concentration of zinc in 0.1 N HCl is then added.
  • a dry powder of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is added and dissolved with stirring.
  • the pH is adjusted to about 3 to aid dissolution if necessary with small quantities of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH.
  • the pH is then adjusted to 7.6 with 10% HCl and 10% NaOH. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • a second solution is prepared by dissolving sodium phosphate dibasic (3.78 parts by mass), phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass) in water for injection (1000 parts by volume).
  • Protamine sulfate powder (0.6 parts by mass) is then dissolved in this solution.
  • the pH of this solution is adjusted to 7.6.
  • This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter.
  • Equal volumes of this protamine solution and the B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin solution are combined.
  • An amorphous precipitate forms immediately which becomes crystalline upon standing for 60 hours undisturbed at a controlled temperature of 25° C.
  • the microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin.
  • B29-N ⁇ -(2-ethylhexanoyl)-human insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5. A mass (8.00 mg) of B29-N ⁇ -(2-ethylhexanoyl)-human insulin was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl. Thereafter, the procedure of Preparation 17 was followed essentially. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C. Rod-like crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%).
  • the crystals of B29-N ⁇ -2-ethylhexanoyl-human insulin had a t1 ⁇ 2 of 34-35 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Groups G (5 males) and H (5 females) were treated for two days with a crystal formulation according to the present invention, as described in this example. Each rat was given daily injections of its group's formulation for the two days before blood glucose was determined, and on the day that the blood glucose was determined.
  • Blood was obtained half an hour before administering the test formulations. Animals were injected subcutaneously with either 0.9 U/100 g body weight (males) or 1.1 U/100 g body weight (females) at 11:30 A.M. Blood was obtained by nicking the tail (not anaesthetized), stored briefly on ice, centrifuged, and glucose determined using a Beckman II glucose analyzer. Blood samples were obtained just prior to administering the test formulations, and at 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 hours after administration. The crystal formulations of the present invention controlled blood glucose for a time comparable to that obtained with the long-acting insulin preparations.
  • Example 2 The testing procedure described above in Example 2 was repeated with a second 5 mL sample of a U40 formulation of a suspension, prepared as described above.
  • Blood was obtained half an hour before administering the test formulations. Animals were injected subcutaneously with either 0.9 U/100 g body weight (males) or 1.1 U/100 g body weight (females) at 11:30 A.M. Blood was obtained by nicking the tail (not anaesthetized), stored briefly on ice, centrifuged, and glucose determined using a Beckman II glucose analyzer. Blood samples were obtained just prior to administering the test formulations, and at 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 hours after administration. The crystal formulations of the present invention controlled blood glucose for a time comparable to that obtained with the long-acting insulin preparations.
  • Blood was obtained half an hour before administering the test formulations. Animals were injected subcutaneously with either 0.9 U/100 g body weight (males) or 1.1 U/100 g body weight (females) at 11:30. Blood was obtained by nicking the tail (not anaesthetized), stored briefly on ice, centrifuged, and glucose determined using a Beckman II glucose analyzer. Blood samples were obtained just prior to administering the test formulations, and at 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 hours after administration. The crystal formulations of the present invention controlled blood glucose for a time comparable to that obtained with the long-acting insulin preparations.
  • Kefzol Eli Lilly & Co., Indianapolis, Ind.
  • Keflex was administered post-operatively (250 mg, p.o. once daily for seven days) to prevent infections.
  • Torbugesic 1.5 mg/kg, I.M. was administered post-operatively to control pain.
  • Plasma glucose concentrations were determined the day of the study using a glucose oxidase method in a Beckman glucose analyzer (Beckman Instruments, Inc., Brea, Calif.). Samples for other assays were stored at ⁇ 80° C. until time for analysis. Insulin concentrations were determined using a double antibody radioimmunoassay.
  • amorphous precipitate of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin provided effective control of blood glucose for almost 27 hours, compared with only about 21 hours for human insulin ultralente.
  • the precipitate provided a significantly flatter and a more extended control of glucose levels than did human insulin ultralente.
  • the nadir of the blood glucose concentration was obtained after 1.5 hours for the precipitate, and then the glucose level rose to a fairly constant level.
  • the nadir for human insulin ultralente was reached after 9 hours, and after that, the blood glucose level rose relatively quickly.
  • the glucose level at the nadir was 72 mg/dL for the derivatized insulin precipitate formulation, while it was 56 mg/dL for the. ultralente formulation.
  • plasma insulin levels corroborate these observations, and correlate well with the greater flatness and extension of time action of the amorphous precipitate of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin compared with human insulin ultralente.
  • a dose of a formulation of microcrystals of B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin prepared essentially as described in Preparation 19 was administered subcutaneously to each of five dogs at a dose of 3 nmol/kg.
  • the dogs received a constant infusion of somatostatin to create a transient diabetic state.
  • microcrystals comprising B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin, administered at 2 nmol/kg, had an effective time action of 27 hours, compared with 21 hours for human insulin NPH at the same dose.
  • the glucodynamic profile showed less hypoglycemic tendency than human insulin NPH, which is an advantageous quality.
  • the microcrystals comprising B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin effectively controlled glucose levels for at least 30 hours. At the glucose nadir, about the same glucose level was obtained as that obtained after administration of human insulin NPH (namely, about 65 mg/dL).
  • the duration of such depressed glucose levels was much shorter for the microcrystals comprising B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin (about 3 hours) compared with human insulin NPH (about 7.5 hours).
  • blood glucose levels for the group receiving microcrystals comprising B29-N ⁇ -octanoyl-human insulin varied only between 91 and 115 mg/dL up to 30 hours, after which no further data are available.
  • glucose levels in the group the received human insulin NPH at 2 nmol/kg varied from 89 to 145 after the nadir was reached.
  • the glucodynamic profile was flatter, showing less hypoglycemic tendency than human insulin NPH.
  • At the glucose nadir about the same glucose level was obtained as that obtained after administration of human insulin NPH (namely, about 67 mg/dL, versus 64 mg/dL for human insulin NPH).
  • the duration of such depressed glucose levels was much shorter for the microcrystals comprising B29-N ⁇ -hexanoyl-human insulin (about 3 hours) compared with human insulin NPH (about 7.5 hours).

Abstract

The present invention relates to insoluble compositions containing acylated proteins selected from the group consisting of acylated insulin, acylated insulin analog, and acylated proinsulin, and formulations thereof. The formulations are suitable for parenteral delivery or other means of delivery, to a patient for extended control of blood glucose levels. More particularly, the present invention relates to compositions comprised of an acylated protein complexed with zinc, protamine, and a phenolic compound such that the resulting microcrystal is analogous to the neutral protamine Hagedorn (NPH) insulin crystal form. Surprisingly, it has been discovered that compositions of such acylated proteins have therapeutically superior subcutaneous release pharmacokinetics, and more extended and flatter glucodynamics, than presently available commercial preparations of NPH insulin. Yet, the present crystals retain certain advantageous properties of NPH crystals, being readily able to be resuspended and also mixable with soluble insulins.

Description

  • This application claims priority to U.S. Provisional Application Serial No. 60/063104, filed on Oct. 24, 1997, and U.S. Provisional Application Serial No. 60/088930, filed Jun. 11, 1998.[0001]
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • 1. Field of the Invention [0002]
  • This invention is in the field of human medicine. More particularly, this invention is in the field of pharmaceutical treatment of the diseases of diabetes and hyperglycemia. [0003]
  • 2. Description of Related Art [0004]
  • It has long been a goal of insulin therapy to mimic the pattern of endogenous insulin secretion in normal individuals. The daily physiological demand for insulin fluctuates and can be separated into two phases: (a) the absorptive phase requiring a pulse of insulin to dispose of the meal-related blood glucose surge, and (b) the post-absorptive phase requiring a sustained delivery of insulin to regulate hepatic glucose output for maintaining optimal fasting blood glucose. [0005]
  • Accordingly, effective therapy for people with diabetes generally involves the combined use of two types of exogenous insulin formulations: a rapid acting meal time insulin provided by bolus injections and a long-acting, so-called, basal insulin, administered by injection once or twice daily to control blood glucose levels between meals. An ideal basal insulin will provide an extended and “flat” time action—that is, it will control blood glucose levels for at least 12 hours, and preferably for 24 hours or more, without significant risk of hypoglycemia. Furthermore, an ideal basal insulin should be mixable with a soluble meal-time insulin, and should not cause irritation or reaction at the site of administration. Finally, basal insulin preparations that are suspension formulations should be able to be readily, and uniformly resuspended by the patient prior to administration. [0006]
  • As is well understood by those skilled in this art, long-acting insulin formulations have been obtained by formulating normal insulin as microcrystalline suspensions for subcutaneous injection. Examples of commercial basal insulin preparations include NPH (Neutral Protamine Hagedorn) insulin, protamine zinc insulin (PZI), and ultralente (UL). NPH insulin is the most widely-used insulin preparation, constituting from 50 to 70 percent of the insulin used worldwide. It is a suspension of a microcrystalline complex of insulin, zinc, protamine, and one or more phenolic preservatives. NPH insulin preparations are commercially available incorporating human insulin, pork insulin, beef insulin, or mixtures thereof. Also, NPH-like preparations of a monomeric insulin analog, LysB298, ProB29-human insulin analog, are known in the art [abbreviated herein as “NPL”: De Felippis, M. R., U.S. Pat. No. 5,461,031, issued Oct. 24, 1995; De Felippis, M. R., U.S. Pat. No. 5,650,486, issued Jul. 22, 1997; and De Felippis, M. R., U.S. Pat. No. 5,747,642, issued May 5, 1998]. [0007]
  • NPH insulin microcrystals possess a distinctive rod-shaped morphology of typical dimensions about 5 microns long by 1 micron thick and 1 micron wide. The extended duration of action of NPH insulin microcrystals results from their slow absorption from the subcutaneous injection site. [0008]
  • Therapy using currently-available NPH insulin preparations fails to provide the ideal “flat” pharmacokinetics necessary to maintain optimal fasting blood glucose for an extended period of time between meals. Consequently, treatment with NPH insulin can result in undesirably high levels of insulin in the blood, which may cause life-threatening hypoglycemia. [0009]
  • In addition to failing to provide an ideal flat pharmacokinetic profile, the duration of action of NPH insulin also is not ideal. In particular, a major problem with NPH therapy is the “dawn phenomenon” which is hyperglycemia that results from the loss of effective glucose control overnight while the patient is sleeping. These deficiencies in glycemic control contribute to serious long-term medical complications of diabetes and impose considerable inconvenience and quality-of-life disadvantages to the patient. [0010]
  • Protamine zinc insulin (PZI) has a composition similar to NPH, but contains higher levels of protamine and zinc than NPH. PZI preparations may be made as intermediate-acting amorphous precipitates or long-acting hacrystalline material. PZI, however, is not an ideal basal insulin pharmaceutical because it is not mixable with a soluble meal-time insulin, and the high zinc and protamine can cause irritation or reaction at the site of administration. [0011]
  • Human insulin ultralente is a microcrystalline preparation of insulin having higher levels of zinc than NPH, and not having either protamine or a phenolic preservative incorporated into the microcrystal. Human ultralente preparations provide moderate time action that is not suitably flat, and they do not form stable mixtures with insulin. Furthermore, they are difficult to resuspend. [0012]
  • There have been attempts to address the perceived inadequacies of known insulin suspensions. Fatty acid-acylated insulins have been investigated for basal control of blood glucose [Havelund, S., et al., WIPO publication WO95/07931, Mar. 23, 1995]. Their extended time action is caused by binding of the fatty acyl portion of these molecules to serum albumin. The fatty acyl chain lengths of these molecules is such as to take advantage of the fatty acid binding capability of serum albumin. The fatty acid chains used in fatty acid-acylated insulins are typically longer than about ten carbon atoms, and chain lengths of fourteen and sixteen carbon atoms are optimal for binding to serum albumin and extending time action. [0013]
  • Unlike NPH insulin, which is insoluble, the aforementioned fatty acid-acylated insulins are soluble at the usual therapeutic concentrations of insulin. However, the time action of these preparations may not be sufficiently long enough, or flat enough, to provide ideal, basal control, and they are less potent than insulin, thereby requiring administration of greater amounts of the drug agent [Radziuk, J., et al., [0014] Diabetoloia 41:116-120, 489-490 (1998)].
  • Whittingham, J. L., et al. [[0015] Biochemistry 36:2826-2831 (1997)] crystallized B29-Nε-tetradecanoyl-des(B30)-human insulin analog as a hexamer complex with zinc and phenol for the purpose of structural studies by X-ray crystallography. The hexamer was found to be in the R6 conformation, and to have certain properties different from hexamers of human insulin. Whittingham, et al. do not disclose any pharmaceutical or pharmacological properties of the crystal that was formed, nor do they suggest that such a crystal would have any advantageous properties for treating diabetes or hyperglycemia. It is not possible to predict from Whittingham, et al. whether protamine-containing crystals of the NPH type could be formed with derivatized insulins and insulin analogs, or what the pharmacokinetice or pharmacodynamic response of such crystals would be.
  • Thus, there remains a need to identify insulin preparations that have flatter and longer time action than NPH insulin, that are mixable with soluble, meal-time insulins, that can be readily resuspended, and that do not pose risk of irritation or reaction at the site of administration. [0016]
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • I have unexpectedly observed that when insulin is made less soluble by derivatizing one or more of its reactive side groups, the derivatized insulin can be incorporated into NPH-like crystals with protamine. When the derivatized protein is precipitated or crystallized, the rate at which the insulin derivative dissolves from the solid form is greatly reduced compared with the rate at which similar solid forms comprised of un-derivatized protein dissolve. I have furthermore discovered that crystals of derivatized proteins provide flatter and longer time action than do crystals comprised of un-derivatized protein. Additionally, I have surprisingly discovered that the benefits of flatter and longer time action can be obtained even from amorphous precipitates comprising derivatized protein. [0017]
  • Accordingly, in its broadest aspect, the present invention provides insoluble compositions comprising a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of insulin derivatives, insulin analog derivatives, and proinsulin derivatives, wherein the derivatives are less soluble than the underivatized insulin, insulin analog, or proinsulin. The insoluble compositions also are comprised of a complexing compound, a hexamer-stabilizing compound, and a divalent metal cation. These insoluble compositions are useful for treating diabetes and hyperglycemia, and provide the advantages of having flatter and longer time action than NPE insulin. Furthermore, they are mixable in a formulation with soluble protein and with soluble derivatized protein. The insoluble compositions of the present invention are in the form of amorphous precipitates, and also more preferably, in the form of microcrystals. [0018]
  • More specifically, the present invention provides microcrystalline forms of fatty acid-acylated proteins that are useful for treating diabetes and hyperglycemia. These microcrystals comprise a fatty acid-acylated protein selected from the group consisting of fatty acid-acylated insulin, fatty acid-acylated insulin analog, and fatty acid-acylated proinsulin, protamine, a phenolic preservative, and zinc. Such microcrystals will provide both flatter and longer time action than NPH insulin, and are mixable with soluble proteins and soluble derivatized proteins. [0019]
  • The invention provides aqueous suspension formulations comprising the insoluble composition and an aqueous solvent. Such suspension formulations may contain, optionally, a soluble protein, such as human insulin, or a soluble analog of human insulin, such as a monomeric insulin analog, that control blood glucose immediately following a meal. The microcrystalline formulations of fatty acid-acylated insulins have superior pharmacodynamics compared with human insulin NPH. The present invention is distinct from previous fatty acid-acylated insulin technology in that the extension of time action of the present invention does not rely necessarily on albumin-binding, though albumin binding may further protract the time action of certain of the compositions of the present invention. [0020]
  • The invention also pertains to a process for preparing the insoluble compositions, and a method of treating diabetes or hyperglycemia comprising administering a formulation containing an insoluble composition to a patient in need thereof in a quantity sufficient to regulate blood glucose levels in the patient. [0021]
  • Also part of the present invention are amorphous precipitates, comprising, in their broadest aspect, a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of derivatized insulin, derivatized insulin analog, and derivatized proinsulin, protamine, a phenolic preservative, and zinc, wherein the derivatized protein is less soluble than the underivatized protein. [0022]
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWING
  • The dissolution rate of pork insulin NPH (- - -) and of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals of this invention (------) are compared in FIG. 1.[0023]
  • DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
  • The term “insoluble composition” refers to matter in either a microcrystalline state or in an amorphous precipitate state. The presence of microcrystals or amorphous precipitate can be ascertained by visual and microscopic examination. Solubility depends on solvent, and a particular composition may be insoluble in one solvent, but soluble in another. [0024]
  • The term “microcrystal” means a solid that is comprised primarily of matter in a crystalline state, wherein the individual crystals are predominantly of a single crystallographic composition and are of a microscopic size, typically of longest dimension within the range 1 micron to 100 microns. The term “microcrystalline” refers to the state of being a microcrystal. [0025]
  • The term “amorphous precipitate” refers to Winsoluble material that is not crystalline in form. The person of ordinary skill can distinguish crystals from amorphous precipitate. The amorphous precipitates of the present invention have advantageous pharmacological properties in their own right, and also are intermediates in the formation of the microcrystals of the present invention. [0026]
  • The term “derivatized protein” refers to a protein selected from the group consisting of derivatized insulin, derivatized insulin analogs, and derivatized proinsulin that is derivatized by a functional group such that the derivatized protein is less soluble in an aqueous solvent than is the un-derivatized protein. Many examples of such derivatized proteins are known in the art, and the determination of solubility of proteins and derivatized proteins is well-known to the skilled person. Examples of derivatized insulin and insulin analogs include benzoyl, p-tolyl-sulfonamide carbonyl, and indolyl derivatives of insulin and insulin analogs [Havelund, S., et al., WO95/07931, published Mar. 23, 1995]; alkyloxycarbonyl derivatives of insulin [Geiger, R., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 3,684,791, issued Aug. 15, 1972; Brandenberg, D., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 3,907,763, issued Sep. 23, 1975]; aryloxycarbonyl derivatives of insulin [Brandenberg, D., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 3,907,763, issued Sep. 23, 1975]; alkylcarbamyl derivatives [Smyth, D. G., U.S. Pat. No. 3,864,325, issued Feb. 4, 1975; Lindsay, D. G., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 3,950,517, issued Apr. 13, 1976]; carbamyl, O-acetyl derivatives of insulin [Smyth, D. G., U.S. Pat. No. 3,864,325 issued Feb. 4, 1975]; cross-linked, alkyl dicarboxyl derivatives [Brandenberg, D., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 3,907,763, issued Sep. 23, 1975]; N-carbamyl, O-acetylated insulin derivatives [Smyth, D. G., U.S. Pat. No. 3,868,356, issued Feb. 25, 1975]; various O-alkyl esters [Markussen, J., U.S. Pat. No. 4,343,898, issued Aug. 10, 1982; Morihara, K., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,400,465, issued Aug. 23, 1983; Morihara, K., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,401,757, issued Aug. 30, 1983; Markussen, J., U.S. Pat. No. 4,489,159, issued Dec 18, 1984; Obermeier, R., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,601,852, issued Jul. 22, 1986; and Andresen, F. H., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,601,979, issued Jul. 22, 1986]; alkylamide derivatives of insulin [Balschmidt, P., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,430,016, issued Jul. 4, 1995]; various other derivatives of insulin [Lindsay, D. G., U.S. Pat. No. 3,869,437, issued Mar. 4, 1975]; and the fatty acid-acylated proteins that are described herein. [0027]
  • The term “acylated protein” as used herein refers to a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of insulin, insulin analogs, and proinsulin that is acylated with an organic acid moiety that is bonded to the protein through an amide bond formed between the acid group of an organic acid compound and an amino group of the protein. In general, the amino group may be the α-amino group of an N-terminal amino acid of the protein, or may be the ε-amino group of a Lys residue of the protein. An acylated protein may be acylated at one or more of the three amino groups that are present in insulin and in most insulin analogs. Mono-acylated proteins are acylated at a single amino group. Di-acylated proteins are acylated at two amino groups. Tri-acylated proteins are acylated at three amino groups. The organic acid compound may be, for example, a fatty acid, an aromatic acid, or any other organic compound having a carboxylic acid group that will form an amide bond with an amino group of a protein, and that will cause the aqueous solubility of the derivatized protein to be lower than the solubility of the un-derivatized protein. [0028]
  • The term “fatty acid-acylated protein” refers to a an acylated protein selected from the group consisting of insulin, insulin analogs, and proinsulins that is acylated with a fatty acid that is bonded to the protein through an amide bond formed between the acid group of the fatty acid and an amino group of the protein. In general, the amino group may be the α-amino group of an N-terminal amino acid of the protein, or may be the ε-amino group of a Lys residue of the protein. A fatty acid-acylated protein may be acylated at one or more of the three amino groups that are present in insulin and in most insulin analogs. Mono-acylated proteins are acylated at a single amino group. Di-acylated proteins are acylated at two amino groups. Tri-acylated proteins are acylated at three amino groups. Fatty acid-acylated insulin is disclosed in a Japanese patent application 1-254, 699. See also, Hashimoto, M., et al., [0029] Pharmaceutical Research, 6:171-176 (1989), and Lindsay, D. G., et al., Biochemical J. 121:737-745 (1971). Further disclosure of fatty acid-acylated insulins and fatty acylated insulin analogs, and of methods for their synthesis, is found in Baker, J. C., et al, U.S. Ser. No. 08/342,931, filed Nov. 17, 1994 and issued as U.S. Pat. No. 5,693,609, Dec. 2, 1997; Havelund, S., et al., WO95/07931, published Mar. 23, 1995, and a corresponding U.S. Pat. No. 5,750,497, May 12, 1998; and Jonassen, I., et al., WO96/29342, published Sep. 26, 1996. These disclosures are expressly incorporated herein by reference for describing fatty acid-acylated insulins and fatty acid-acylated insulin analogs and for enabling preparation of the same.
  • The term “fatty acid-acylated protein” includes pharmaceutically acceptable salts and complexes of fatty acid-acylated proteins. The term “fatty acid-acylated protein” also includes preparations of acylated proteins wherein the population of acylated protein molecules is homogeneous with respect to the site or sites of acylation. For example, Nε-mono-acylated protein, B1-Nα-mono-acylated protein, A1-Nα-mono-acylated protein, A1, B1-Nα-di-acylated protein, Nε, A1-Nα, di-acylated protein, Nε, B1-Nα, di-acylated protein, and Nε, A1, B1-Nα, tri-acylated protein are all encompassed within the term “fatty acid-acylated proteins” for the purpose of the present invention. The term also refers to preparations wherein the population of acylated protein molecules has heterogeneous acylation. In the latter case, the term “fatty acid-acylated protein” includes mixtures of mono-acylated and di-acylated proteins, mixtures of mono-acylated and tri-acylated proteins, mixtures of di-acylated and tri-acylated proteins, and mixtures of mono-acylated, di-acylated, and tri-acylated proteins. [0030]
  • The term “insulins” as used herein, refers to human insulin, whose amino acid sequence and special structure are well-known. Human insulin is comprised of a twenty-one amino acid A-chain and a thirty-amino acid B-chain which are cross-linked by disulfide bonds. A properly cross-linked insulin contains three disulfide bridges: one between position 7 of the A-chain and position 7 of the B-chain, a second between position 20 of the A-chain and position 19 of the B-chain, and a third between positions 6 and 11 of the A-chain. [0031]
  • The term “insulin analog” means proteins that have an A-chain and a B-chain that have substantially the same amino acid sequences as the A-chain and B-chain of human insulin, respectively, but differ from the A-chain and B-chain of human insulin by having one or more amino acid deletions, one or more amino acid replacements, and/or one or more amino acid additions that do not destroy the insulin activity of the insulin analog. [0032]
  • “Animal insulins” are insulin analogs. Four such animal insulins are rabbit, pork, beef, and sheep insulin. The amino acid substitutions that distinguish these animal insulins from human insulin are presented below for the reader's convenience. [0033]
    Amino Acid Position
    A8 A9 A10 B30
    human insulin Thr Ser Ile Thr
    rabbit insulin Thr Ser Ile Ser
    pork insulin Thr Ser Ile Ala
    beef insulin Ala Ser Val Ala
    sheep insulin Ala Gly Val Ala
  • Another type of insulin analog, “monomeric insulin analog” is well-known in the art. Monomeric insulin analogs are structurally very similar to human insulin, and have activity similar or equal to human insulin, but have one or more amino acid deletions, replacements or additions that tend to disrupt the contacts involved in dimerization and hexamerization which results in their greater tendency to dissociate to less aggregated states. Monomeric insulin analogs are rapid-acting analogs of human insulin, and are disclosed, for example, in Chance, R. E., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,646, May 7, 1996; Brems, D. N., et al. [0034] Protein Engineering 5:527-533 (1992); Brange, J. J. V., et al., EPO publication No. 214,826, published Mar. 18, 1987; Brange, J. J. V., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,618,913, Apr. 8, 1997; and Brange, J., et al., Current Opinion in Structural Biology 1:934-940 (1991). An example of monomeric insulin analogs is described as human insulin wherein Pro at position B28 is substituted with Asp, Lys, Leu, Val, or Ala, and wherein Lys at position B29 is Lys or is substituted with Pro, and also, AlaB26-human insulin, des(B28-B30)-human insulin, and des(B27)-human insulin. The monomeric insulin analogs employed as derivatives in the present crystals, or employed un-derivatized in the solution phase of suspension formulations, are properly cross-linked at the same positions as is human insulin.
  • Another group of insulin analogs for use in the present invention are those wherein the isoelectric point of the insulin analog is between about 7.0 and about 8.0. These analogs are referred to as “pI-shifted insulin analogs.” Examples of such insulin analogs include ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, ArgA0, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, and ArgA0, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0035]
  • Another group of insulin analogs consists of insulin analogs that have one or more amino acid deletions that do not significantly disrupt the activity of the molecule. This group of insulin analogs is designated herein as “deletion analogs.” For example, insulin analogs with deletion of one or more amino acids at positions B1-B3 are active. Likewise, insulin analogs with deletion of one or more amino acids at positions B28-B30 are active. Examples of “deletion analogs” include des(B30)-human insulin, desPhe(B1)-human insulin, des(B27)-human insulin, des(B28-B30)-human insulin, and des(B1-B3)-human insulin. The deletion analogs employed as derivatives in the present crystals, or employed un-derivatized in the solution phase of suspension formulations, are properly cross-linked at the same positions as is human insulin. [0036]
  • Optionally, an insulin analog may have replacements of one or more of its amidated amino acids with other amino acids for the sake of chemical stability. For example, Asn and Gln may be replaced with Gly, Ser, Thr, Asp or Glu. In particular, AsnAl8, AsnA21, or AsnB3, or any combination of those residues may be replaced by Gly, Asp, or Glu, for example. Also, GlnA15 or GlnB4, or both, may be replaced by either Asp or Glu. Preferred replacements are Asp at B21, and Asp at B3. [0037]
  • The term “proinsulin” means a single-chain peptide molecule that is a precursor of insulin. Proinsulin may be converted to insulin or to an insulin analog by chemical or, preferably, enzyme-catalyzed reactions. In proinsulin, proper disulfide bonds are formed as described herein. Proinsulin comprises insulin or an insulin analog and a connecting bond or a connecting peptide. A connecting peptide has between 1 and about 35 amino acids. The connecting bond or connecting peptide connects to a terminal amino acid of the A-chain and to a terminal amino acid of the B-chain by an α-amide bond or by two α-amide bonds, respectively. Preferably, none of the amino acids in the connecting peptide is cysteine. Preferably, the C-terminal amino acid of the connecting peptide is Lys or Arg. Proinsulin may have the formula X—B—C—A—Y or may have the formula X—A—C—B—Y, wherein X is hydrogen or is a peptide of from 1 to about 100 amino acids that has either Lys or Arg at its C-terminal amino acid, Y is hydroxy, or is a peptide of from 1 to about 100 amino acids that has either Lys or Arg at its N-terminal amino acid, A is the A-chain of insulin or the A-chain of an insulin analog, C is a peptide of from 1 to about 35 amino acids, none of which is cysteine, wherein the C-terminal amino acid is Lys or Arg, and B is the B-chain of insulin or the B-chain of an insulin analog. [0038]
  • A “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” means a salt formed between any one or more of the charged groups in a protein and any one or more pharmaceutically acceptable, non-toxic cations or anions organic and inorganic salts include, for example, those prepared from acids such as hydrochloric, sulfuric, sulfonic, tartaric, fumaric, hydrobromic, glycolic, citric, maleic, phosphoric, succinic, acetic, nitric, benzoic, ascorbic, p-toluenesulfonic, benzenesulfonic, naphthalenesulfonic, propionic, carbonic, and the like, or for example, ammonium, sodium, potassium, calcium, or magnesium. [0039]
  • The verb “acylate” means to form the amide bond between a fatty acid and an amino group of a protein. A protein is “acylated” when one or more of its amino groups is combined in an amide bond with the acid group of a fatty acid. [0040]
  • The term “fatty acid” means a saturated or unsaturated, straight chain or branched chain fatty acid, having from one to eighteen carbon atoms. [0041]
  • The term “C1 to C18 fatty acid” refers to a saturated, straight chain or branched chain fatty acid having from one to eighteen carbon atoms. [0042]
  • The term “divalent metal cation” refers to the ion or ions that participate to form a complex with a multiplicity of protein molecules. The transition metals, the alkaline metals, and the alkaline earth metals are examples of metals that are known to form complexes with insulin. The transitional metals are preferred. Zinc is particularly preferred. Other transition metals that may be pharmaceutically acceptable for complexing with insulin proteins include copper, cobalt, and iron. [0043]
  • The term “complex” has two meanings in the present invention. In the first, the term refers to a complex formed between one or more atoms in the proteins that form the complex and one or more divalent metal cations. The atoms in the proteins serve as electron-donating ligands. The proteins typically form a hexamer complex with divalent transition metal cations. The second meaning of “complex” in the present invention is the association between the complexing compound and hexamers. The “complexing compound” is an organic molecule that typically has a multiplicity of positive charges that binds to, or complexes with hexamers in the insoluble composition, thereby stabilizing them against dissolution. Examples of complexing compounds suitable in the present invention include protamine, surfen, various globin proteins [Brange, J. , Galenics of Insulin, Springer-Verlag, Berlin Heidelberg (1987)], and various polycationic polymer compounds known to complex with insulin. [0044]
  • The term “protamine” refers to a mixture of strongly basic proteins obtained from fish sperm. The average molecular weight of the proteins in protamine is about 4,200 [Hoffmann, J. A., et al., [0045] Protein Expression and Purification, 1:127-133 (1990)]. “Protamine” can refer to a relatively salt-free preparation of the proteins, often called “protamine base.” Protamine also refers to preparations comprised of salts of the proteins. Commercial preparations vary widely in their salt content.
  • Protamines are well-known to those skilled in the insulin art and are currently incorporated into NPH insulin products. A pure fraction of protamine is operable in the present invention, as well as mixtures of proteins. Commercial preparations of protamine, however, are typically not homogeneous with respect to the proteins present. These are nevertheless operative in the present invention. Protamine comprised of protamine base is operative in the present invention, as are protamine preparations comprised of salts of protamine, and those that are mixtures of protamine base and protamine salts. Protamine sulfate is a frequently used protamine salt. [0046]
  • The term “suspension” refers to a mixture of a liquid phase and a solid phase that consists of insoluble or sparingly soluble particles that are larger than colloidal size. Mixtures of NPH microcrystals and an aqueous solvent form suspensions. Mixtures of amorphous precipitate and an aqueous solvent also forms a suspension. The term “suspension formulation” means a pharmaceutical composition wherein an active agent is present in a solid phase, for example, a microcrystalline solid, an amorphous precipitate, or both, which is finely dispersed in an aqueous solvent. The finely dispersed solid is such that it may be suspended in a fairly uniform manner throughout the aqueous solvent by the action of gently agitating the mixture, thus providing a reasonably uniform suspension from which a dosage volume may be extracted. Examples of commercially available insulin suspension formulations include, for example, NPH, PZI, and ultralente. A small proportion of the solid matter in a microcrystalline suspension formulation may be amorphous. Preferably, the proportion of amorphous material is less than 10%, and most preferably, less than 1% of the solid matter in a microcrystalline suspension. Likewise, a small proportion of the solid matter in an amorphous precipitate suspension may be microcrystalline. [0047]
  • “NPH insulin” refers to the “Neutral Protamine Hagedorn” preparation of insulin. The meaning of such a term, and the methods for preparing such a preparation of insulin will be familiar to the person of ordinary skill in the insulin formulation art. [0048]
  • The term “aqueous solvent” refers to a liquid solvent that contains water. An aqueous solvent system may be comprised solely of water, may be comprised of water plus one or more miscible solvents, and may contain solutes. The more commonly-used miscible solvents are the short-chain organic alcohols, such as, methanol, ethanol, propanol, short-chain ketones, such as acetone, and polyalcohols, such as glycerol. [0049]
  • An “isotonicity agent” is a compound that is physiologically tolerated and imparts a suitable tonicity to a formulation to prevent the net flow of water across cell membranes that are in contact with an administered formulation. Glycerol, which is also known as glycerin, is commonly used as an isotonicity agent. Other isotonicity agents include salts, e.g., sodium chloride, and monosaccharides, e.g., dextrose and lactose. [0050]
  • The insoluble compositions of the present invention contain a hexamer-stabilizing compound. The term “hexamer-stabilizing compound” refers to a non-proteinaceous, small molecular weight compound that stabilizes the derivatized protein in a hexameric aggregation state. Phenolic compounds, particularly phenolic preservatives, are the best known stabilizing compounds for insulin and insulin derivatives. Such a hexamer-stabilizing compound stabilizes the insulin hexamer by binding to it through specific inter-molecular contacts. Examples of such hexamer-stabilizing agents include: various phenolic compounds, phenolic preservatives, resorcinol, 4′-hydroxyacetanilide (tylenol), 4-hydroxybenzamide, and 2,7-dihydroxynaphthalene. Multi-use formulations of the insoluble compositions of the present invention will contain a preservative, in addition to a hexamer-stabilizing compound. The preservative used in formulations of the present invention may be a phenolic preservative. [0051]
  • The term “preservative” refers to a compound added to a pharmaceutical formulation to act as an anti-microbial agent. A parenteral formulation must meet guidelines for preservative effectiveness to be a commercially viable multi-use product. Among preservatives known in the art as being effective and acceptable in parenteral formulations are benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium, chlorohexidine, phenol, m-cresol, benzyl alcohol, methylparaben, chlorobutanole o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, phenylmercuric nitrate, thimerosal, benzoic acid, and various mixtures thereof. See, e.g., Wallhäusser, K.-H., [0052] Develop. Biol. Standard, 24:9-28 (1974) (S. Krager, Basel).
  • The term “phenolic preservative” includes the compounds phenol, m-cresol, o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, methylparaben, and mixtures thereof. Certain phenolic preservatives, such as phenol and m-cresol, are known to bind to insulin-like molecules and thereby to induce conformational changes that increase either physical or chemical stability, or both [Birnbaum, D. T., et al., [0053] Pharmaceutical. Res. 14:25-36 (1997); Rahuel-Clermont, S., et al., Biochemistry 36:5837-5845 (1997)].
  • The term “buffer” or “pharmaceutically acceptable buffer” refers to a compound that is known to be safe for use in insulin formulations and that has the effect of controlling the pH of the formulation at the pH desired for the formulation. The pH of the formulations of the present invention is from about 6.0 to about 8.0. Preferably the formulations of the present invention have a pH between about 6.8 and about 7.8. Pharmaceutically acceptable buffers for controlling pH at a moderately acidic pH to a moderately basic pH include such compounds as phosphate, acetate, citrate, arginine, TRIS, and histidine. “TRIS” refers to 2-amino-2-hydroxymethyl-1,3,-propanediol, and to any pharmacologically acceptable salt thereof. The free base and the hydrochloride form are two common forms of TRIS. TRIS is also known in the art as trimethylol aminomethane, tromethamine, and tris(hydroxymethyl)aminomethane. Other buffers that are pharmaceutically acceptable, and that are suitable for controlling pH at the desired level are known to the chemist of ordinary skill. [0054]
  • The term “administer” means to introduce a formulation of the present invention into the body of a patient in need thereof to treat a disease or condition. [0055]
  • The term “treating” refers to the management and care of a patient having diabetes or hyperglycemia, or other condition for which insulin administration is indicated for the purpose of combating or alleviating symptoms and complications of those conditions. Treating includes administering a formulation of present invention to prevent the onset of the symptoms or complications, alleviating the symptoms or complications, or eliminating the disease, condition, or disorder. [0056]
  • As mentioned above, the present invention provides insoluble compositions that have properties similar to NPH insulin in certain respects, and superior to NPH insulin in other respects. They are similar to NPH insulin in respect to their physical properties. A light microscope equipped with an oil immersion objective and a crossed polarizer was utilized to examine microcrystals comprised of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin, zinc, protamine, and phenol, prepared according to the method of Preparation 18. Examination at 1000× magnification showed that the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals were single and rod-like like, exhibiting a uniform crystal morphology. The sizes of these microcrystals fell generally within the range of approximately 2 microns long to 8 microns long. A direct comparison using this microscope showed that the morphology of these microcrystals appeared to be similar to that of commercially manufactured pork NPH microcrystals, which has elsewhere been described as rod-like. The size range of these B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals was also similar to that of commercially manufactured NPH microcrystals, which generally have an average length of about 5 microns. The commercial manufacturing specification for the mean length of NPH microcrystals is from 1 micron to 40 microns. [0057]
  • The microcrystals of the present invention are, however, unexpectedly and unpredictably different from NPH insulin crystals in their dissolution properties, and in their time action. In particular, the microcrystals of the present invention dissolve much more slowly under conditions that simulate physiologic conditions than do NPH insulin crystals, and provide a longer and flatter profile of blood glucose control than does NPH insulin. This was demonstrated by the following experiments. [0058]
  • Certain derivatized proteins, in soluble form, were found to have time actions not significantly different from regular human insulin. Three groups of animals were used. Each animal in the first group received a dose (0.75 nmol/kg) of Humulin® R (soluble human insulin), each animal in the second group received a dose (0.75 nmol/kg) of soluble B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (“C8-hI”) and each animal in the third group received a dose (0.75 nmol/kg) of soluble B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin (“C10-hI”) The experiments were carried out essentially as described in Example 5, with five dogs per group. The proteins were administered subcutaneously. Blood glucose concentrations were determined, and are presented in the table below. [0059]
  • Table 1. Blood glucose concentrations before and after administration of Humulin® R, soluble B29-Nε-octanoyl-buan insulin (“C8-hI”), or soluble B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin (“C10-hI”) in normal dogs simultaneously administered somatostatin to create a transient diabetic state. Values are mean±standard error. [0060]
    Blood Glucose Concentration (mg/dL)
    Time
    (h) Humulin ® R Soluble C8-hI Soluble C10-hI
    −0.5 110 ± 2  115 ± 4  108 ± 2 
    0 101 ± 2  101 ± 7  96 ± 4 
    0.5 83 ± 5  80 ± 5  85 ± 6 
    1 54 ± 6  52 ± 4  70 ± 5 
    1.5 49 ± 4  51 ± 2  57 ± 4 
    2 48 ± 4  51 ± 2  52 ± 4 
    2.5 55 ± 4  60 ± 3  56 ± 4 
    3 59 ± 2  65 ± 4  58 ± 4 
    3.5 65 ± 2  73 ± 5  63 ± 4 
    4 71 ± 2  85 ± 6  68 ± 4 
    5 87 ± 2  110 ± 8  79 ± 3 
    6 104 ± 3  124 ± 4  91 ± 7 
    7 119 ± 8  145 ± 14  106 ± 8 
    8 144 ± 5  153 ± 16  119 ± 11 
  • These data clearly show that soluble B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin and B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin, administered subcutaneously to normal dogs in a transient diabetic state, provide glucose lowering roughly comparable to that obtained with soluble human insulin. Most notably, soluble B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin shows a quicker onset, and shorter time action than does human insulin. [0061]
  • In a second experiment, the dissolution rate of crystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin prepared in accordance with the present invention was found to be markedly longer than that of a commercially manufactured NPH-pork insulin. This was most unexpected in view of the data above. The dissolution rate of the NPH-pork insulin was measured by placing 5 microliters of U100 NPH-pork insulin into 3 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium or magnesium) in a 1 cm path length square quartz cuvette at a temperature of 22° C. This solution was stirred at a constant rate using a magnetic cuvette stirrer. Absorbance measurements at 320 nm were taken at 1 minute intervals. The absorbance at 320 nm corresponds to the light scattered by the insoluble particles present in the aqueous suspension. Consequently, as the microcrystals dissolve, the absorbance approaches zero. The data generated from this experiment are presented in FIG. 1 as the dashed line, and show that the pork NPH microcrystals were completely dissolved after about 1 hour. [0062]
  • An analogous procedure was followed to measure the dissolution rate of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals. A volume of 12 microliters of a suspension of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals (containing no more than 50 U/mL), prepared according to the procedure of Preparation 18, was placed into 3 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium or magnesium) in a 1 cm path length square quartz cuvette. This solution was stirred at the same constant rate and at the same temperature of 22° C. The data generated from this experiment are presented in FIG. 1 as the solid line, and show that the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals required much more than 5 hours to dissolve. [0063]
  • These experiments. establish that, in Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium and magnesium), a solution that mimics the interstitial fluid in certain aspects, the rate of dissolution of the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals is significantly slower than that of pork NPH microcrystals. Again, this finding was very surprising in light of the previous finding that soluble B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin had a time action actually slightly shorter than did human insulin![0064]
  • Subcutaneous interstitial fluid contains 0.3 mM human serum albumin. Therefore, another experiment was designed to compare the dissolution rates of approximately equal quantities of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals and pork NPH microcrystals in Dulbeccols phosphate buffered saline containing 0.3 mM human serum albumin. [0065]
  • This experiment was performed by placing 25 microliters of NPH pork insulin (approximately 3.5 mg insulin/mL) into 2 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium and magnesium) containing 0.3 mM human serum albumin. The resulting suspension was swirled gently by hand whereupon the microcrystals were observed to be dissolved after about 3 to 5 minutes. [0066]
  • The rate of dissolution of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals was observed by placing 50 microliters of a B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystalline formulation (approximately 1.8 mg/mL), prepared essentially as described in Preparation 18 herein, into 2 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium and magnesium) containing 0.3 mM human serum albumin. The resulting suspension was swirled gently by hand for about 3 to 5 minutes whereupon minimal dissolution of the suspended microcrystals was observed to have taken place. Continued gentle stirring of this solution using a magnetic stirrer resulted in complete dissolution of the suspended B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals after about 2 hours. [0067]
  • These experiments establish that the rate of dissolution of the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystals is significantly slower than the rate of dissolution of commercially manufactured pork NPH microcrystals in Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium and magnesium) containing 0.3 mM human serum albumin. [0068]
  • Because the time action profile of NPH insulin preparations is related strongly to the rate of dissolution of the microcrystals in the subcutaneous interstitial fluid, it is concluded from these experiments that the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin microcrystalline suspension formulation will possess a more protracted duration of action when administered subcutaneously to diabetic patients than existing commercial NPH insulin preparations. [0069]
  • The insoluble compositions of the present invention may be crystals with rod-like morphology or with an irregular morphology, or they may be amorphous precipitates. Preferred insoluble compositions are comprised of acylated insulin or acylated insulin analog, zinc ions, which are present at about 0.3 to about 0.7 mole per mole of derivatized protein, a phenolic preservative selected from the group consisting of phenol, m-cresol, o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, methylparaben, and mixtures thereof and is present in sufficient proportions with respect to the derivatized protein to facilitate formation of the R6 hexamer conformation, and protamine, which is present at about 0.15 to about 0.7 mole per mole of derivatized protein. [0070]
  • The preferred derivatized proteins are acylated proteins, and the preferred acylated proteins for the microcrystals and formulations of the present invention are fatty acid-acylated insulin, and fatty acid-acylated insulin analogs. Fatty acid-acylated human insulin is highly preferred. Fatty acid-acylated insulin analogs are equally highly preferred. [0071]
  • A preferred group of insulin analogs for preparing acylated insulin analogs used to form the microcrystals of the present invention consists of insulin analogs wherein the amino acid residue at position B28 is Asp, Lys, Leu, Val, or Ala, the amino acid residue at position B29 is Lys or Pro, the amino acid residue at position B10 is His or Asp, the amino acid residue at position B3 is Phe, Asp or deleted alone or in combination with a deletion of the residue at position B2, the amino acid residue at position B30 is Thr, Ala, Ser, or deleted, and the amino acid residue at position B9 is Ser or Asp; provided that either position B28 or B29 is Lys. [0072]
  • Another preferred group of insulin analogs for use in the present invention consists of those wherein the isoelectric point of the insulin analog is between about 7.0 and about 8.0. These analogs are referred to as “pI-shifted insulin analogs.” Examples of pI-shifted insulin analogs include, for example, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, ArgA0, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, and ArgA0, GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0073]
  • Another preferred group of insulin analogs consists of LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (B28 is Lys; B29 is Pro); AspB28-human insulin (B28 is Asp), AspB1-human insulin, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin, ArgA0-human insulin, AspB1, GluB13-human insulin, AlaB26-human insulin, GlyA21-human insulin, des(ThrB30)-human insulin, and GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0074]
  • Especially preferred insulin analogs include LysB28, ProB29-human insulin, des(ThrB30)-human insulin, AspB28-human insulin, and AlaB26-human insulin. Another especially preferred insulin analog is GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin [Dörschug, M., U.S. Pat. No. 5,656,722, Aug. 12, 1997]. The most preferred insulin analog is LysB28, ProB29-human insulin. [0075]
  • One preferred group of acylating moieties consists of fatty acids that are straight chain and saturated. This group consists of methanoic acid (C1), ethanoic acid (C2), propanoic acid (C3), n-butanoic acid (C4), n-pentanoic acid (C5), n-hexanoic acid (C6), n-heptanoic acid (C7), n-octanoic acid (C[0076] 8), n-nonanoic acid (C9), n-decanoic acid (C10), n-undecanoic acid (C11), n-dodecanoic acid (C12), n-tridecanoic acid (C13), n-tetradecanoic acid (C14), n-pentadecanoic acid (CIS), n-hexadecanoic acid (C16), n-heptadecanoic acid (C17), and n-octadecanoic acid (C18). Adjectival forms are formyl (C1), acetyl (C2), propionyl (C3), butyryl (C4), pentanoyl (C5), hexanoyl (C6), heptanoyl (C7), octanoyl (C8), nonanoyl (C9), decanoyl (C10), undecanoyl (C11), dodecanoyl (C12), tridecanoyl (C13), tetradecanoyl (C14) or myristoyl, pentadecanoyl (C15), hexadecanoyl (C16) or palmitic, heptadecanoyl (C17), and octadecanoyl (C18).
  • A preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having an even number of carbon atoms—that is, C2, C4, C6, C8, C10, C12, C14, C16, and C18 saturated fatty acids. [0077]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having an odd number of carbon atoms—that is, C1, C3, C5, C7, C9, C11, C13, C15, and C17 saturated fatty acids. [0078]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than 5 carbon atoms—that is, C6, C7, C8, C9, C10, C11, C12, C13, C14, C15, C16, C17, and C18 saturated fatty acids. [0079]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having less than 9 carbon atoms—that is, C1, C2, C3, C4, C5, C6, C7, and C18 saturated fatty acids. [0080]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having between 6 and B carbon atoms—that is, C6, C7, and C8, saturated fatty acids. [0081]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than between 4 and 6 carbon atoms—that is, C4, C5, and C6, saturated fatty acids. [0082]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than between 2 and 4 carbon atoms—that is, C2, C3, and C4, saturated fatty acids. [0083]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having less than 6 carbon atoms—that is, C1, C2, C3, C4, and C5 saturated fatty acids. [0084]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having less than 4 carbon atoms—that is, C1, C2, and C3 saturated fatty acids. [0085]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having more than 9 carbon atoms—that is, C10, C11, C12, C13, C14, C15, C16, C17, and C18 saturated fatty acids. [0086]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having an even number of carbon atoms and more than 9 carbon atom—that is, C10, C12, C14, C16, and C18 saturated fatty acids. [0087]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having 12, 14, or 16 carbon atoms, that is, C12, C14, and C16 saturated fatty acids. [0088]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having 14 or 16 carbon atoms, that is, C14 and C16 saturated fatty acids. Fatty acids with 14 carbons are particularly preferred. Fatty acids with 16 carbons are also particularly preferred. [0089]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of saturated fatty acids having between 4 and 10 carbon atoms, that is C4, C5, C6, C7, C8, C9, and C10 saturated fatty acids. [0090]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of saturated fatty acids having an even number of carbon atoms between 4 and 10 carbon atoms, that is C4, C6, C8, and C10 saturated fatty acids. [0091]
  • Another preferred group of fatty acids for forming the fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of fatty acids having between 6, 8, or 10 carbon atoms. Fatty acids with 6 carbons are particularly preferred. Fatty acids with a carbons are also particularly preferred. Fatty acids with 10 carbons are particularly preferred. [0092]
  • The skilled person will appreciate that narrower preferred groups are made by combining the preferred groups of fatty acids described above. [0093]
  • Another preferred group of acylating moieties consists of saturated fatty acids that are branched. A branched fatty acid has at least two branches. The length of a ubranchu of a branched fatty acid may be described by the number of carbon atoms in the branch, beginning with the acid carbon. For example, the branched fatty acid 3-ethyl-5-methylhexanoic acid has three branches that are five, six, and six carbons in length. In this case, the “longest” branch is six carbons. As another example, 2,3,4,5-tetraethyloctanoic acid has five branches that are 4, 5, 6, 7, and 8 carbons long. The “longest” branch is eight carbons. A preferred group of branched fatty acids are those having from three to ten carbon atoms in the longest branch. [0094]
  • A representative number of such branched, saturated fatty acids will be mentioned to assure the reader's comprehension of the range of such fatty acids that may be used as acylating moieties of the proteins in the present invention: 2-methyl-propioinic acid, 2-methyl-butyric acid, 3-methyl-butyric acid, 2,2-dimethyl-propionic acid, 2-methyl-pentanoic acid, 3-methyl-pentanoic acid, 4-methyl-pentanoic acid, 2,2-dimethyl-butyric acid, 2,3-dimethyl-butyric acid, 3,3-dimethyl-butyric acid, 2-ethyl-butyric acid, 2-methyl-hexanoic acid, 5-methyl-hexanoic acid, 2,2-dimethyl-pentanoic acid, 2,4-dimethyl-pentanoic acid, 2-ethyl-3-methyl-butyric acid, 2-ethyl-pentanoic acid, 3-ethyl-pentanoic acid, 2,2-dimethyl-3-methyl-butyric acid, 2-methyl-heptanoic acid, 3-methyl-heptanoic acid, 4-methyl-heptanoic acid, 5-methyl-heptanoic acid, 6-methyl-heptanoic acid, 2,2-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 2,3-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 2,4-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 2,5-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 3,3,-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 3,4-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 3,5-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 4,4-dimethyl-hexanoic acid, 2-ethyl-hexanoic acid, 3-ethyl-hexanoic acid, 4-ethyl-hexanoic acid, 2-propyl-pentanoic acid, 2-ethyl-hexanoic acid, 3-ethyl-hexanoic acid, 4-ethyl-hexanoic acid, 2-(1-propyl)pentanoic acid, 2-(2-propyl)pentanoic acid, 2,2-diethyl-butyric acid, 2,3,4-trimethyl-pentanoic acid, 2-methyl-octanoic acid, 4-methyl-octanoic acid, 7-methyl-octanoic acid, 2,2-dimethyl-heptanoic acid, 2,6-dimethyl-heptanoic acid, 2-ethyl-2-methyl-hexanoic acid, 3-ethyl-5-methyl-hexanoic acid, 3-(1-propyl)-hexanoic acid, 2-(2-butyl)-pentanoic acid, 2-(2-(2-methylpropyl))pentanoic acid, 2-methyl-nonanoic acid, 8-methyl-nonanoic acid, 6-ethyl-octanoic acid, 4-(1-propyl)-heptanoic acid, 5-(2-propyl)-heptanoic acid, 3-methyl-undecanoic acid, 2-pentyl-heptanoic acid, 2,3,4,5,6-pentamethyl-heptanoic acid, 2,6-diethyl-octanoic acid, 2-hexyl-octanoic acid, 2,3,4,5,6,7-hexamethyl-octanoic acid, 3,3-diethyl-4,4-diethyl-hexanoic acid, 2-heptyl-nonanoic acid, 2,3,4,5-tetraethyl-octanoic acid, 2-octyl-decanoic acid, and 2-(1-propyl)-3-(1-propyl)-4,5-diethyl-6-methyl-heptanoic acid. [0095]
  • Yet another preferred group of acylating moieties consists of cyclic alkyl acids having from 5 to 24 carbon atoms, wherein the cyclic alkyl moiety, or moieties, have 5 to 7 carbon atoms. A representative number of such cyclic alkyl acids will be mentioned to assure the reader's comprehension of the range of such acids that may be used as acylating moieties of the proteins in the present invention: cyclopentyl-formic acid, cyclohexyl-formic acid, 1-cyclopentyl-acetic acid, 2-cyclohexyl-acetic acid, 1,2-dicyclopentyl-acetic acid, and the like. [0096]
  • A preferred group of derivatized proteins for use in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of mono-acylated proteins. Mono-acylation at the ε-amino group is most preferred. For insulin, mono-acylation at LysB29 is preferred. Similarly, for certain insulin analogs, such as, LysB2B, ProB29-human insulin analog, mono-acylation at the ε-amino group of LysB28 is most preferred. Mono-acylation at the α-amino group of the B-chain (B1) is also preferred. Mono-acylation at the α-amino group of the A-chain (A1) is also preferred. [0097]
  • Another preferred group of acylated proteins for use in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of di-acylated proteins. The di-acylation may be, for example, at the ε-amino group of Lys and at the α-amino group of the B-chain, or may be at the ε-amino group of Lys and at the α-amino group of the A-chain, or may be at the α-amino group the A-chain and at the α-amino group of the B-chain. [0098]
  • Another preferred group of acylated proteins for use in the microcrystals of the present invention consists of tri-acylated proteins. Tri-acylated proteins are those that are acylated at the ε-amino group of Lys, at the α-amino group of the B-chain, and at the α-amino group of the A-chain. [0099]
  • It is also preferred to use acylated proteins that are a mixture of mono-acylated and di-acylated proteins. [0100]
  • It is likewise preferred to use acylated proteins that are a mixture of mono-acylated and tri-acylated proteins. [0101]
  • Another preferred group of acylated proteins consists of a mixture of di-acylated and tri-acylated proteins. [0102]
  • Also preferred is to use acylated proteins that are a mixture of mono-acylated, di-acylated, and tri-acylated proteins. [0103]
  • Certain fatty acid-acylated proteins used in the present microcrystals will be mentioned to assure the reader's comprehension of the scope of the present invention. The list is illustrative, and the fact that a particular fatty acid-acylated protein is not mentioned does not mean that a microcrystal containing it is not within the scope of the present invention. [0104]
  • B29-Nε-Formyl-human insulin. [0105]
  • B1-Nα-Formyl-human insulin. [0106]
  • A1-Nα-Formyl-human insulin. [0107]
  • B29-Nε-Formyl-, B1-N-formyl-human insulin. [0108]
  • B29-Nε-Formyl-, A1-Nα-formyl-human insulin. [0109]
  • A1-NαFormyl-, B1-Nα-formyl-human insulin. [0110]
  • B29-Nε-Formyl-, A1-Nα-formyl-, B1-Nα-formyl-human insulin. [0111]
  • B29-Nε-Acetyl-huaan insulin. [0112]
  • B1-Nα-Acetyl-human insulin. [0113]
  • A1-Nα-Acetyl-human insulin. [0114]
  • B29-Nε-Acetyl-, B1-Nα-acetyl-human insulin. [0115]
  • B29-Nε-Acetyl-, A1-Nα-acetyl-human insulin. [0116]
  • A1-Nα-Acetyl-, B1-Nα-acetyl-human insulin. [0117]
  • B29-Nε-Acetyl-, A1-Nα-acetyl-, B1-Nα-acetyl-human insulin. [0118]
  • B29-Nε-Propionyl-human insulin. [0119]
  • B1-Nα-Propionyl-human insulin. [0120]
  • A1-Nα-Propionyl-human insulin. [0121]
  • B29-Nε-Propionyl-, B1-Nα-propionyl-human insulin. [0122]
  • B29-Nε-Propionyl-, A1-Nα-propionyl-human insulin. [0123]
  • A1-Nα-Propionyl-, B1-Nα-propionyl-human insulin. [0124]
  • B29-Nε-Propionyl-, A1-Nα-propionyl-, B1-Nα-propionyl-human insulin. [0125]
  • B29-Nε-Butyryl-human insulin. [0126]
  • B1-Nα-Butyryl-human insulin. [0127]
  • A1-Nα-Butyryl-human insulin. [0128]
  • B29-Nε-Butyryl-, B1-Nα-butyryl-human insulin. [0129]
  • B29-Nε-Butyryl-, A1-Nα-butyryl-human insulin. [0130]
  • A1-Nα-Butyryl-, B1-Nα-butyryl-human insulin. [0131]
  • B29-Nε-Butyryl-, A1-Nα-butyryl-, B1-Nα-butyryl-human insulin. [0132]
  • B29-Nε-Pentanoyl-human insulin. [0133]
  • B1-Nα-Pentanoyl-human insulin. [0134]
  • A1-Nα-Pentanoyl-human insulin. [0135]
  • B29-Nε-Pentanoyl-, B1-Nα-pentanoyl-human insulin. [0136]
  • B29-Nε-Pentanoyl-, A1-Nα-pentanoyl-human insulin. [0137]
  • A1-Nα-Pentanoyl-, B1-Nα-pentanoyl-human insulin. [0138]
  • B29-Nε-Pentanoyl-, A1-Nα-pentanoyl-, B1-Nα-pentanoyl-human insulin. [0139]
  • B29-Nε-Hexanoyl-human insulin. [0140]
  • B1-Nα-Hexanoyl-human insulin. [0141]
  • A1-Nα-Hexanoyl-human insulin. [0142]
  • B29-Nε-Hexanoyl-, B1-Nα-hexanoyl-human insulin. [0143]
  • B29-Nε-Hexanoyl-, A1-Nα-hexanoyl-human insulin. [0144]
  • A1-Nα-Hexanoyl-, B1-Nα-hexanoyl-human insulin. [0145]
  • B29-Nε-Hexanoyl-, A1-Nα-hexanoyl-, B1-Nα-hexanoyl-human insulin. [0146]
  • B29-Nε-Heptanoyl-human insulin. [0147]
  • B1-Nα-Heptanoyl-human insulin. [0148]
  • A1-Nα-Heptanoyl-human insulin. [0149]
  • B29-Nε-Heptanoyl-, B1-Nα-heptanoyl-human insulin. [0150]
  • B29-Nε-Heptanoyl-, A1-Nα-heptanoyl-human insulin. [0151]
  • A1-Nα-Heptanoyl-, B1-Nα-heptanoyl-human insulin. [0152]
  • B29-Nε-Heptanoyl-, A1-Nα-heptanoyl-, B1-Nα-heptanoyl-human insulin. [0153]
  • B29-Nε-Octanoyl-human insulin. [0154]
  • B1-Nα-Octanoyl-human insulin. [0155]
  • A1-Nα-Octanoyl-human insulin. [0156]
  • B29-Nε-Octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-human insulin. [0157]
  • B29-Nε-Octanoyl-, A1-Nα-octanoyl-human insulin. [0158]
  • A1-Nα-Octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-human insulin. [0159]
  • B29-Nε-Octanoyl-, A1-Nα-octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-human insulin. [0160]
  • B29-Nε-Nonanoyl-human insulin. [0161]
  • B1-Nα-Nonanoyl-human insulin. [0162]
  • A1-Nα-Nonanoyl-human insulin. [0163]
  • B29-Nε-Nonanoyl-, B1-Nα-nonanoyl-human insulin. [0164]
  • B29-Nε-Nonanoyl-, A1-Nα-nonanoyl-human insulin. [0165]
  • A1-Nα-Nonanoyl-, B1-Nα-nonanoyl-human insulin. [0166]
  • B29-Nε-Nonanoyl-, A1-Nα-nonanoyl-, B1-Nα-nonanoyl-human insulin. [0167]
  • B29-Nε-Decanoyl-human insulin. [0168]
  • B1-Nα-Decanoyl-human insulin. [0169]
  • A1-Nα-Decanoyl -human insulin. [0170]
  • B29-Nε-Decanoyl-, B1-Nα-decanoyl-human insulin. [0171]
  • B29-Nε-Decanoyl-, A1-Nα-decanoyl-human insulin. [0172]
  • A1-Nα-Decanoyl-, B1-Nα-decanoyl-human insulin. [0173]
  • B29-Nε-Decanoyl-, A1-Nα-decanoyl-, B1-Nα-decanoyl-human insulin; [0174]
  • B28-Nε-Formyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0175]
  • B1-Nα-Formyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0176]
  • A1-Nα-Formyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0177]
  • B28-Nε-Formyl-, B1-Nα-formyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0178]
  • B28-Nε-Formyl-, A1-Nα-formyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0179]
  • A1-Nα-Formyl-, B1-Nα-formyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0180]
  • B28-Nε-Formyl-, A1-Nα-formyl-, B1-Nα-formyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0181]
  • B28-Nε-Acetyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0182]
  • B1-Nα-Acetyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0183]
  • A1-Nα-Acetyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0184]
  • B28-Nε-Acetyl-, B1-Nα-acetyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0185]
  • B28-Nε-Acetyl-, A1-Nα-acetyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0186]
  • A1-Nα-Acetyl-, B1-Nα-acetyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0187]
  • B28-Nε-Acetyl-, A1-Nα-acetyl-, B1-Nα-acetyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0188]
  • B28-Nε-Propionyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0189]
  • B1-Nα-Propionyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0190]
  • A1-Nα-Propionyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0191]
  • B28-Nε-Propionyl-, B1-Nα-propionyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0192]
  • B28-Nα-Propionyl-, A1-Nα-propionyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0193]
  • A1-Nα-Propionyl-, B1-Nα-propionyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0194]
  • B28-Nε-Propionyl-, A1-Nα-propionyl-, B1-Nα-propionyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0195]
  • B28-Nε-Butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0196]
  • B1-Nα-Butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0197]
  • A1-Nα-Butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0198]
  • B28-Nε-Butyryl-, B1-Nα-butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0199]
  • B28-Nε-Butyryl-, A1-Nα-butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0200]
  • A1-Nα-Butyryl-, B1-Nα-butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0201]
  • B28-Nε-Butyryl-, A1-Nα-butyryl-, B1-Nα-butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0202]
  • B28-Nε-Pentanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0203]
  • B1-Nα-Pentanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0204]
  • A1-Nα-Pentanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0205]
  • B28-Nε-Pentanoyl-, B1-Nα-pentanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0206]
  • B28-Nε-Pentanoyl-, A1-Nα-pentanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0207]
  • A1-Nα-Pentanoyl-, B1-Nα-pentanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0208]
  • B28-Nε-Pentanoyl-, A1-Nα-pentanoyl-, B1-Nα-pentanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0209]
  • B28-Nε-Hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0210]
  • B1-Nα-Hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0211]
  • A1-Nα-Hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0212]
  • B28-Nε-Hexanoyl-, B1-Nα-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0213]
  • B28-Nε-Hexanoyl-, A1-Nα-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0214]
  • A1-Nα-Hexanoyl-, B1-Nα-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0215]
  • B28-Nε-Hexanoyl-, A1-Nα-hexanoyl-, B1-Nα-hexanoyl-LysB26,ProB29-human insulin analog. [0216]
  • B28-Nε-Heptanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0217]
  • B1-Nα-Heptanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0218]
  • A1-Nα-Heptanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0219]
  • B28-Nε-Heptanoyl-, B1-Nα-heptanoy-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0220]
  • B28-Nε-Heptanoyl-, A1-Nα-heptanoyl-LysB28, ProB2 9-human insulin analog. [0221]
  • A1-Nα-Heptanoyl-, B1-Nα-heptanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0222]
  • B28-Nε-Heptanoyl-, A1-Nα-heptanoyl-, B1-Nα-heptanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0223]
  • B28-Nε-Octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0224]
  • B1-Nα-Octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0225]
  • A1-Nα-Octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0226]
  • B28-Nε-Octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0227]
  • B28-Nε-Octanoyl-, A1-Nα-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0228]
  • A1-Nα-Octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0229]
  • B28-Nε-Octanoyl-, A1-Nα-octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0230]
  • B28-Nε-Nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0231]
  • B1-Nα-Nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0232]
  • A1-Nα-Nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0233]
  • B28-Nε-Nonanoyl-, B1-Nα-nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0234]
  • B28-Nε-Nonanoyl-, A1-Nα-nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0235]
  • A1-Nα-Nonanoyl-, B1-Nα-nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0236]
  • B28-Nε-Nonanoyl-, A1-Nα-nonanoyl-, B1-Nα-nonanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0237]
  • B28-Nε-Decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0238]
  • B1-Nα-Decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0239]
  • A1-Nα-Decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0240]
  • B28-Nε-Decanoyl-, B1-Nα-decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0241]
  • B28-Nε-Decanoyl-, A1-Nα-decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0242]
  • A1-Nα-Decanoyl-, B1-Nα-decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0243]
  • B28-Nε-Decanoyl-, A1-Nα-decanoyl-, B1-Nα-decanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog. [0244]
  • B29-Nε-Pentanoyl-GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0245]
  • B1-Nα-Hexanoyl-GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0246]
  • A1-Nα-Heptanoyl-GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0247]
  • B29-Nε-Octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0248]
  • B29-Nε-Propionyl-, A1-Nα-propionyl-GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0249]
  • A1-Nα-Acetyl, B1-Nα-acetyl-GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0250]
  • B29-Nε-Formyl-, A1-Nα-formyl-, B1-Nα-formyl-GlyA21, ArgB31, ArgB32-human insulin. [0251]
  • B29-Nε-Formyl-des (TyrB26)-human insulin. [0252]
  • B1-Nα-Acetyl-AspB28-human insulin. [0253]
  • B29-Nε-Propionyl-, A1-Nα-propionyl-, B1-Nα-propionyl-AspB1, AspB3, AspB21-human insulin. [0254]
  • B29-Nε-Pentanoyl-GlyA21-human insulin. [0255]
  • B1-Nα-Hexanoyl-GlyA22-human insulin. [0256]
  • A1-Nα-Heptanoyl-GlyA21-human insulin. [0257]
  • B29-Nε-Octanoyl-, B1-Nα-octanoyl-GlyA21-human insulin. [0258]
  • B29-Nε-Propionyl-, A1-Nα-propionyl-GlyA21-human insulin. [0259]
  • A1-Nα-Acetyl, B1-Nα-acetyl-GlyA21-human insulin. [0260]
  • B29-Nε-Formyl-, A1-Nα-formyl-, B1-Nα-formyl-GlyA21-human insulin. [0261]
  • B29-Nε-Butyryl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin. [0262]
  • B1-Nα-Butyryl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin. [0263]
  • A1-Nα-Butyryl-des(ThrB30)human insulin. [0264]
  • B29-Nε-Butyryl-, B1-Nα-butyryl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin. [0265]
  • B29-Nε-Butyryl-, A1-Nα-butyryl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin. human insulin. [0266]
  • A1-Nα-Butyrly-, B1-Nα-butyryl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin. [0267]
  • B29Nε-Butyryl-, A1-Nα-butyrly-, B1Nα-butyryl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin. [0268]
  • Aqueous compositions containing water as the major solvent are preferred. Aqueous suspensions wherein water is the solvent are highly preferred. [0269]
  • The compositions of the present invention are used to treat patients who have diabetes or hyperglycemia. The formulations of the present invention will typically provide derivatized protein at concentrations of from about 1 mg/ML to about 10 mg/mL. Present formulations of insulin products are typically characterized in terms of the concentration of units of insulin activity (units/mL), such as U40, U50, U100, and so on, which correspond roughly to about 1.4, 1.75, and 3.5 mg/mL preparations, respectively. The dose, route of administration, and the number of administrations per day will be determined by a physician considering such factors as the therapeutic objectives, the nature and cause of the patient's disease, the patient's gender and weight, level of exercise, eating habits, the method of administration, and other factors known to the skilled physician. In broad range, a daily dose would be in the range of from about 1 nmol/kg body weight to about 6 nmol/kg body weight (6 nmol is considered equivalent to about 1 unit of insulin activity). A dose of between about 2 and about 3 nmol/kg is typical of present insulin therapy. [0270]
  • The physician of ordinary skill in treating diabetes will be able to select the therapeutically most advantageous means to administer the formulations of the present invention. Parenteral routes of administration are preferred. Typical routes of parenteral administration of suspension formulations of insulin are the subcutaneous and intramuscular routes. The compositions and formulations of the present invention may also be administered by nasal, buccal, pulmonary, or occular routes. [0271]
  • Glycerol at a concentration of 12 mg/mL to 25 mg/mL is preferred as an isotonicity agent. Yet more highly preferred for isotonicity is to use glycerol at a concentration of from about 15 mg/mL to about 17 mg/mL. [0272]
  • M-cresol and phenol, or mixtures thereof, are preferred preservatives in formulations of the present invention. [0273]
  • Insulin, insulin analogs, or proinsulins used to prepare derivatized proteins can be prepared by any of a variety of recognized peptide synthesis techniques including classical (solution) methods, solid phase methods, semi-synthetic methods, and more recent recombinant DNA methods. For example, see Chance, R. B., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,646, May 7, 1996; EPO publication number 383,472, Feb. 7, 1996; Brange, J. J. V., et al. EPO publication number 214,826, Mar. 18, 1987; and Belagaje, R. M., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,304,473, Apr. 19, 1994, which disclose the preparation of various proinsulin and insulin analogs. These references are expressly incorporated herein by reference. [0274]
  • Generally, derivatized proteins are prepared using methods known in the art. The publications listed above to describe derivatized proteins contain suitable methods to prepared derivatized proteins. Those publications are expressly incorporated by reference for methods of preparing derivatized proteins. To prepare acylated proteins, the protein is reacted with an activated organic acid, such as an activated fatty acid. Activated fatty acids are derivatives of commonly employed acylating agents, and include activated esters of fatty acids, fatty acid halides, activated amides of fatty acids, such as, activated azolide derivatives [Hansen, L. B., WIPO Publication No. 98/02460, Jan. 22, 1998], and fatty acid anhydrides. The use of activated esters, especially N-hydroxysuccinimide esters of fatty acids, is a particularly advantageous means of acylating a free amino acid with a fatty acid. Lapidot, et al. describe the preparation of N-hydroxysuccinimide esters and their use in the preparation of N-lauroyl-glycine, N-lauroyl-L-serine, and N-lauroyl-L-glutamic acid. The term “activated fatty acid ester” means a fatty acid which has been activated using general techniques known in the art [Riordan, J. F. and Vallee, B. L., [0275] Methods in Enzymology, XXV:494-499 (1972); Lapidot, Y., et al., J. Lipid Res. 8:142-145 (1967)]. Hydroxybenzotriazide (HOBT), N-hydroxysuccinimide and derivatives thereof are particularly well known for forming activated acids for peptide synthesis.
  • To selectively acylate the ε-amino group, various protecting groups may be used to block the α-amino groups during the coupling. The selection of a suitable protecting group is known to one skilled in the art and includes p-methoxybenzoxycarbonyl (pmZ). Preferably, the ε-amino group is acylated in a one-step synthesis without the use of amino-protecting groups. A process for selective acylation at the Nε-amino group of Lys is disclosed and claimed by Baker, J. C., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,646,242, Jul. 8, 1997, the entire disclosure of which is incorporated expressly by reference. A process for preparing a dry powder of an acylated protein is disclosed and claimed by Baker, J. C., et al., U.S. Pat. No. 5,700,904, Dec. 23, 1997, the entire disclosure of which is incorporated herein expressly by reference. [0276]
  • The primary role of zinc in the present invention is to facilitate formation of Zn(II) hexamers of the derivatized protein. Zinc is known to facilitate the formation of hexamers of insulin, and of insulin analogs. Zinc likewise promotes the formation of hexamers of derivatized insulin and insulin analogs. Hexamer formation is conveniently achieved by bringing the pH of a solution comprising derivatized protein into the neutral region in the presence of Zn(II) ions, or by adding Zn(II) after the pH has been adjusted to the neutral region. [0277]
  • For efficient yield of microcrystals or amorphous precipitate, the ratio of zinc to derivatized protein in the microcrystal and amorphous precipitate of the present invention is bounded at the lower limit by about 0.33, that is, two zinc atoms per hexamer of derivatized protein which are needed for efficient hexamerization. The microcrystal and amorphous precipitate compositions will form suitably with about 2 to about 4-6 zinc atoms present. Even more zinc may be used during the process if a compound that competes with the protein for zinc binding, such as citrate or phosphate, is present. Excess zinc above the amount needed for hexamerization may be desirable to more strongly drive hexamerization. Also, excess zinc above the amount needed for hexamerization can be present in a formulation of the present invention, and may be desirable to improve chemical and physical stability, to improve suspendability, and possibly to extend time-action further. Consequently there is a fairly wide range of zinc:protein ratios allowable in the formulations of the present invention. [0278]
  • In accordance with the present invention, zinc is present in the formulation in an amount of from about 0.3 mole to about 7 moles per mole of derivatized protein and more preferably about from 0.3 mole to about 1.0 mole of derivatized protein. Yet more highly preferred is a ratio of zinc to derivatized protein from about 0.3 to about 0.7 mole of zinc atoms per mole of derivatized protein. Most highly preferred is a ratio of zinc to derivatized protein from about 0.30 to about 0.55 mole of zinc atoms per mole of derivatized protein. For higher zinc formulations that are similar to PZI preparations, the zinc ratio is from about 5 to about 7 moles of zinc per mole of derivatized protein. [0279]
  • The zinc compound that provides zinc for the present invention may be any pharmaceutically acceptable zinc compound. The addition of zinc to insulin preparations is known in the art, as are pharmaceutically acceptable sources of zinc. Preferred zinc compounds to supply zinc for the present invention include zinc chloride, zinc acetate, zinc citrate, zinc oxide, and zinc nitrate. [0280]
  • A complexing compound is required for the microcrystals and precipitates of the present invention. The complexing compound must be present in sufficient quantities to cause substantial precipitation and crystallization of hexamers of the derivatized protein. Such quantities can be readily determined for a particular preparation of a particular complexing compound by simple titration experiments. Ideally, the complexing compound concentration is adjusted so that there is negligible complexing compound remaining in the soluble phase after completion of precipitation and crystallization. This requires combining the complexing compound based on an experimentally determined “isophane” ratio. This ratio is expected to be very similar to that of NPh and NPL. [0281]
  • However, it may be slightly different because acylation may affect the nature of the protein-protamine interaction. [0282]
  • When protamine is the complexing compound, it is present in the microcrystal in an amount of from about 0.15 mg to about 0.5 mg per 3.5 mg of the derivatized protein. The ratio of protamine to derivatized protein is preferably from about 0.25 to about 0.40 (mg/mg). More preferably the ratio is from about 0.25 to about 0.38 (mg/mg). Preferably, protamine is in an amount of 0.05 mg to about 0.2 mg per mg of the derivatized protein, and more preferably, from about 0.05 to about 0.15 milligram of protamine per milligram of derivatized protein. Protamine sulfate is the preferred salt form of protamine for use in the present invention. [0283]
  • To further extend the time action of the compositions of the present invention or to improve their suspendability, additional protamine and zinc may be added after crystallization. Thus, also within the present invention are formulations having protamine at higher than isophane ratios. For these formulations, the protamine ratio is from 0.25 mg to about 0.5 mg of protamine per mg of derivatized protein. [0284]
  • A required component of the microcrystals and precipitates of the present invention is a hexamer stabilizing compound. The structures of three hexameric conformations have been characterized in the literature, and are designated T6, T3R3, and R6. In the presence of hexamer stabilizing compound, such as various phenolic compounds, the R6 conformation is stabilized. Therefore, it is highly likely that hexamers are in the R6 conformation, or the T3R3 conformation in the crystals and precipitates produced in the presence of a hexamer stabilizing compound, such as phenol. A wide range of hexamer stabilizing compounds are suitable. At least 2 moles of hexamer stabilizing compound per hexamer of derivatized protein are required for effective hexamer stabilization. It is preferred that at least 3 moles of hexamer stabilizing compound per hexamer of derivatized protein be present in the microcrystals and precipitates of the present invention. The presence of higher ratios of hexamer stabilizing compound, at least up to 25 to 50-fold higher, in the solution from which the microcrystals and precipitates are prepared will not adversely affect hexamer stabilization. [0285]
  • In formulations of the present invention, a preservative may be present, especially if the formulation is intended to be sampled from multiple times. As mentioned above, a wide range of suitable preservatives are known. Preferably, the preservative is present in the solution in an amount suitable to provide an antimicrobial effect sufficient to meet pharmacopoeial requirements. [0286]
  • Preferred preservatives are the phenolic preservatives, which are enumerated above. Preferred concentrations for the phenolic preservative are from about 2 mg to about 5 mg per milliliter of the aqueous suspension formulation. These concentrations refer to the total mass of phenolic preservatives because mixtures of individual phenolic preservatives are contemplated. Suitable phenolic preservatives include, for example, phenol, m-cresol, and methylparaben. Preferred phenolic compounds are phenol and m-cresol. Mixtures of phenolic compounds, such as phenol and m-cresol, are also contemplated and highly preferred. Examples of mixtures of phenolic compounds are 0.6 mg/mL phenol and 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, and 0.7 mg/mL phenol and 1.8 mg/mL m-cresol. [0287]
  • The microcrystals of the present invention are preferably oblong-shaped, single crystals composed of derivatized protein complexed with a divalent cation, and including a complexing compound and a hexamer-stabilizing compound. The mean length of the microcrystals of the present invention preferably is within the range of 1 micron to 40 microns, and more preferably is within the size range of 3 microns to 15 microns. [0288]
  • A preferred composition comprises from about 3 mg to about 6 mg of protamine sulfate per 35 mg of derivatized protein, and from about 0.1 to about 0.4 mg zinc per 35 mg of derivatized protein. Another preferred composition comprises from about 10 mg to about 17 mg of protamine sulfate per 35 mg of derivatized protein, and from about 2.0 to about 2.5 mg zinc per 35 mg of derivatized protein. Another preferred composition comprises, per mL, protamine sulfate, 0.34-0.38 mg; zinc, 0.01-0.04 mg; and derivatized protein, 3.2-3.8 mg. [0289]
  • The use of the present insoluble compositions to prepare a medicament for the treatment of diabetes or hyperglycemia is also contemplated. The amorphous precipitates and crystals of the present invention can be prepared for use in medicaments, or other used, by many different processes. In summary, suitable processes will generally follow the sequence: solubilization, hexamerization, complexation, precipitation, crystallization, and optionally formulation. Solubilization means the dissolution of derivatized protein sufficiently to allow it to form hexamers. Hexamerization refers to the process wherein molecules of derivatized protein bind with zinc(II) atoms to form hexamers. Complexation denotes the formation of insoluble complexes between the hexamers and protamine. Precipitation results typically from the formation of insoluble complexes. Crystallization involves the conversion of precipitated hexamer/protamine complexes into crystals, typically, rod-like crystals. [0290]
  • Solubilization is carried out by dissolving the derivatized protein in an aqueous solvent. The aqueous solvent may be, for example, an acidic solution, a neutral solution, or a basic solution. The aqueous solvent may be comprised partially of a miscible organic solvent, such as ethanol, acetonitrile, dimethylsulfoxide, and the like. Acidic solutions may be, for example, solutions of HCl, advantageously from about 0.01 N HCl to about 1.0 N HCl. Other acids that are pharmaceutically acceptable may be employed as well. Basic solutions may be, for example, solutions of NaOH, advantageously from about 0.01 N NaOH to about 1.0 N NaOH, or higher. Other bases that are pharmaceutically acceptable may be employed as well. For the sake of protein stability, the concentration of acid or base is preferably as low as possible while still being effective to adequately dissolve the derivatized protein. [0291]
  • Many derivatized proteins may be dissolved at neutral pH. Solutions to dissolve derivatized proteins at neutral pH may contain a buffer and optionally, salts, a phenolic compound or compounds, zinc, or an isotonicity agent. [0292]
  • The solution conditions required for hexamerization are those that allow the formation of derivatized protein-zinc hexamers in solution. Typically, hexamerization requires zinc and neutral pH. The presence of a hexamer-stabilizing compound advantageously influences the conformation of the derivatized protein in the hexamer, and promotes the R6 or the T3R3 hexamer conformations. [0293]
  • The complexation step must involve the combination of protamine with hexamer under solution conditions where each is initially soluble. This could be accomplished by combining separate solutions of hexameric derivatized protein and of protamine, or by forming a solution of derivatized protein and protamine at acidic or basic pH, and then shifting the pH to the neutral range. [0294]
  • During crystallization, the solution conditions must stabilize the crystallizing species. Thus, the solution conditions will determine the rate and outcome of the crystallization. Crystallization likely occurs through an equilibrium involving non-crystalline precipitated derivatized-protamine complexes, dissolved derivatized protein-protamine complex, and crystallized derivatized protein-protamine. The conditions chosen for crystallization drive the equilibrium toward crystal formation. Also, in light of the hypothesized equilibrium, the solubility of the derivatized protein is expected to profoundly affect rate and size because a lower solubility will slow the net conversion from precipitate to solution to crystal. Furthermore, it is well-recognized that slowing the rate of crystallization often results in larger crystals. Thus, the crystallization rate and crystal size are thought to depend on the size and nature of the derivatizing moiety on the derivatized protein. [0295]
  • Crystallization parameters that influence the crystallization rate and the size of crystals of the present invention are: acyl group size and nature; temperature; the presence and concentration of compounds that compete with derivatized protein for zinc, such as citrate, phosphate, and the like; the nature and concentration of phenolic compound(s); zinc concentration; the presence and concentration of a miscible organic solvent; the time permitted for crystallization; the pH and ionic strength; buffer identity and concentration; the concentration of precipitants; the presence of seeding materials; the shape and material of the container; the stirring rate; and the total protein concentration. Temperature and the concentration of competing compounds are thought to be of particular importance. [0296]
  • Competing compounds, such as citrate, affect the rate at which crystals form, and indirectly, crystal size and quality. These compounds may exert their effect by forming coordination complexes with zinc in solution, thus competing with the relatively weak zinc binding sites on the surface of derivatized protein hexamer for zinc. Occupation of these weak surface binding sites probably impedes crystallization. Additionally, many derivatized proteins are partially insoluble in the presence of little more than 0.333 zinc per mole of derivatized protein, and the presence of competing compounds restores solubility, and permits crystallization. The exact concentration of competing compound will need to be optimized for each derivatized protein. As an upper limit, of course, is the concentration at which zinc is precipitated by the competing compound, or the concentration at which residual competing compound would be pharmaceutically unacceptable, such as, when it would cause pain or irritation at the site of administration. [0297]
  • An example of a process for preparing the precipitates and crystals of the present invention follows. A measured amount of a powder of the derivatized protein is dissolved in an aqueous solvent containing a phenolic preservative. To this solution is added a solution of zinc as one of its soluble salts, for example Zn(II)Cl[0298] 2, to provide from about 0.3 moles of zinc per mole of derivatized insulin to about 0.7 moles, or to as much as 1.0 moles, of zinc per mole of derivatized insulin. Absolute ethanol, or another miscible organic solvent, may optionally be added to this solution in an amount to make the solution from about 5% to about 10% by volume organic solvent. This solution may then be filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A second solution is prepared by dissolving a measured amount of protamine in water equal to one tenth the concentration by weight of the aforementioned derivatized insulin solution. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. The derivatized insulin solution and the protamine solutions are combined in equal volumes, and the resulting solution is then stirred slowly at room temperature (typically about 20-25° C.) whereupon the microcrystals of the derivatized protein are formed within a period from about 12 hours to about 10 days.
  • The microcrystals may then be separated from the mother liquor and introduced into a different solvent, for storage and administration to a patient. Examples of appropriate aqueous solvents are as follows: water for injection containing 25 mM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol and 16 mg/ML glycerol; water for injection containing 2 mg/mL sodium phosphate dibasic, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol; and water for injection containing 25 mM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 16 mg/ML glycerol. [0299]
  • In a preferred embodiment, the crystals are prepared in a manner that obviates the need to separate the crystals from the mother liquor. Thus, it is preferred that the mother liquor itself be suitable for administration to the patient, or that the mother liquor can be made suitable for administration by dilution with a suitable diluent. The term diluent will be understood to mean a solution comprised of an aqueous solvent in which is dissolved various pharmaceutically acceptable excipients, including without limitation, a buffer, an isotonicity agent, zinc, a preservative, protamine, and the like. [0300]
  • In addition to the derivatized insulin, divalent cation, complexing compound, and hexamer-stabilizing compound, pharmaceutical compositions adapted for parenteral administration in accordance with the present invention may employ additional excipients and carriers such as water miscible organic solvents such as glycerol, sesame oil, aqueous propylene glycol and the like. When present, such agents are usually used in an amount ranging from about 0.5% to about 2.0% by weight based upon the final formulation. Examples of such pharmaceutical compositions include sterile, isotonic, aqueous saline solutions of the derivatized insulin derivative buffered with a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer and pyrogen free. For further information on the variety of techniques using conventional excipients or carriers for parenteral products, please see Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 17th Edition, Mack Publishing Company, Easton, Pa., USA (1985), which is incorporated herein by reference. [0301]
  • In the broad practice of the present invention, it is also contemplated that a formulation may contain a mixture of the microcrystalline formulation and a soluble fraction of the derivatized insulin or a soluble fraction of normal insulin or rapid-acting insulin analog, such as, LysB28, ProB29-human insulin. Such mixtures are designed to provide a combination of meal-time control of glucose levels, which is provided by the soluble insulin, and basal control of glucose levels, which is provided by the insoluble insulin. [0302]
  • The following preparations and examples illustrate and explain the invention. The scope of the invention is not limited to these preparations and examples. Reference to “parts” for solids means parts by weight. Reference to “parts” for liquids means parts by volume. Percentages, when used to express concentration, mean mass per volume (×100). All temperatures are degrees Centigrade (°C.). “TRIS” refers to 2-amino-2-hydroxymethyl-1,3-propanediol. The 1000 part-per-million (ppm) zinc solution was prepared by diluting 1.00 mL of a 10,000 ppm zinc atomic absorption standard solution [Ricca Chemical Company, zinc in dilute nitric acid] with water to a final volume of 10.00 mL. [0303]
  • In many of the preparations described below, the yield of precipitates and crystals was estimated. The yield estimate relied on determination of the amount of derivatized insulin or derivatized insulin analog in the precipitate or crystal, and on an estimate of the amount of the same initially in solution. To determine the amount of derivatized protein, samples of re-dissolved precipitate or crystal, and of the supernatant above the precipitate or crystals, were analyzed by reversed-phase gradient HPLC, as described below. [0304]
  • Briefly, the analytical system relied on a C8 reversed-phase column, at 23° C. The flow rate was 1.0 mL/min and UV detection at 214 nm was used. Solvent A was 0.1% (vol:vol) trifluroacetic acid in 10:90 (vol:vol) acetonitrile:water. Solvent B was 0.1% (vol:vol) trifluroacetic acid in 90:10 (vol:vol) acetonitrile:water. The development program was (minutes, % B): (0.1, 0); (45.1, 75); (50.1, 100); (55, 100); (57, 0); (72, 0). All changes were linear. Other analytical systems could be devised by the skilled person to achieve the same objective. [0305]
  • To prepare for the HPLC analysis, aliquots of the well-mixed suspensions were dissolved by diluting with either 0.01 N HCl or 0.03 N HCl. HPLC analysis of these solutions gave the total mg/mL of derivatized protein. Aliquots of the suspensions were centrifuged for approximately 5 minutes in an Eppendorf 5415C microcentrifuge at 14,000 rpm. The decanted supernatant was diluted with either 0.01 N or 0.1 N HCl and analyzed by HPLC. The precipitate was washed by re-suspending in Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium or magnesium) and re-pelleted by centrifugation. The buffer was decanted and the solid was re-dissolved in 0.01 N HCl. The re-dissolved precipitate was analyzed by HPLC. [0306]
  • HPLC was used to confirm the presence of the expected proteins in the acidified suspension, re-dissolved precipitate, and supernatant and also to determine protein concentrations. The retention times of peaks in the chromatograms of the re-dissolved precipitates were compared with the retention times observed for protamine and the insulin compounds used to make the formulations. The agreement between retention times was always good, showing that the protamine and the derivatized proteins used to make the formulations were actually incorporated in the crystals. Concentrations of derivatized proteins were determined by comparing the appropriate peak areas to the areas of a standard. Protamine concentrations were not quantitated. A 0.22 mg/mL solution of derivatized insulin was used as the standard. A standard containing protamine was run, but only for the purpose of determining the retention time. Protamine concentration was not quantitated. [0307]
  • In many of the preparations described below, a standard spectrophotometric assay was used to determine how rapidly the crystals dissolved in Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (pH 7.4) at room temperature. Significant deviations from the procedure described immediately below are noted where appropriate in the descriptions of the preparations. A spectrophotometer suitable for measuring in the ultraviolet range, and equipped with a 1 cm cuvette and a magnetic cuvette stirrer was used for all the dissolution assays. The cuvette, containing a small stir bar and 3.00 mL of phosphate buffered saline (PBS), was put into the cell compartment of the spectrophotometer. The instrument was set to 320 nm and zeroed against the same buffer. Then 4.0 microliters of a well suspended formulation, usually having a total concentration approximately equivalent to a U50 formulation, or about 1.6 to 1.8 mg/mL, was added to the cuvette. After waiting 1.0 minute for mixing, the optical density at 320 nm was recorded. Since the proteins involved in this work do not absorb light at 320 nm, the decrease in optical density was due to reduction in light scattering as the crystals dissolved. The time for the optical density to drop to half of its initial value is typically reported (t½). As a control, 2.0 microliters of U100 Humulin® N (i.e., human insulin NPH, which is also known as human NPH insulin) was added to 3.00 mL of PBS buffer, and the optical density at 320 nm monitored as above. The dissolution half-time time (t½) for the Humulin® N formulation was about 6 minutes. [0308]
  • Preparation 1 Gly(A21), Arg(B31), Arg(B32)-Human Insulin Analog
  • Gly(A21)Arg(B31)Arg(B32)-human insulin was obtained from an [0309] E. coli fermentation in which a Gly(A21)-human proinsulin precursor molecule was overexpressed into inclusion bodies. A portion (94.7 g) of inclusion bodies was solubilized in 500 mL of 6 M guanidine hydrochloride containing 0.1 M TRIS, 0.27 M sodium sulfite, and 0.1 M sodium tetrathionate, pH 10.5 at room temperature. The pH was quickly lowered to 8.8 with 12 N HCl. After vigorously stirring in an open container for 45 minutes the pH was lowered to 2.1 with phosphoric acid and the sample centrifuged overnight at 4° C. The supernatant was decanted and stored at 4° C for additional processing. The pellet was re-extracted with 200 mL of additional pH 10.5 solution (see above) and then centrifuged for 3 hours at 4° C. This and the previously obtained supernatant were each diluted 4× with 100 mM sodium phosphate, pH 4, precipitating the product and other acidic components. After allowing the precipitate to settle, most of the supernatant was decanted and discarded. The resulting suspension was centrifuged, followed by decanting and discarding of additional supernatant, leaving wet pellets of the crude Gly(A21)-human proinsulin S-sulfonate precursor. The pellets were solubilized in 1.5 liters of 7 M deionized urea, adjusting the pH to 8 with 5 N NaOH and stirring over several hours at 4° C. Salt (NaCl) was then added to achieve 1 M concentration and the sample was loaded onto a XAD-7 column (14 cm×20 cm, Toso-Haas, Montgomeryville, Pa.), previously flushed with 50% acetonitrile/50% 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, 10% acetonitrile/90% 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, and finally with 7 M deionized urea/1M NaCl/20 mm TRIS, pH 8. Once loaded, the column was pumped with 4.5 liters of a 7 M deionized urea/1 M NaCl/20 mM TRIS, pH 8 solution, followed by 2.8 liters of 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate/1 M NaCl, and 6.5 liters of 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate. The column was eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, while monitoring the eluant by UW at 280 nm. The peak of interest, partially purified Gly(A21)-human proinsulin S-sulfonate precursor, was collected, lyophilized, and subjected to a folding/disulfide bond procedure as follows. A quantity (5.4 g) of the precursor was dissolved in 3 liters of 20 mM glycine, pH 10.5, 4° C. Then, 15 mL of 240 mm cysteine HCl were added with stirring, while maintaining the pH at 10.5 and the temperature at 4° C. The reaction solution was stirred gently at 4° C. for 27 hours and then quenched by lowering the pH to 3.1 with phosphoric acid. Acetonitrile (155 ML) was added, and the solution was then loaded onto a 5×25 cm C4 reversed-phase column previously pumped with 60% acetonitrile/40% water/0.1% TFA and equilibrated in 10% acetonitrile/90% water/0.1% TFA. Once loaded the column was pumped with 1 liter of 17.5% acetonitrile/82.5% water/0.1% TFA, then eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 0.1% TFA while monitoring at 280 nm. Selected fractions were pooled and lyophilized with a recovery of 714 mg. For conversion of the proinsulin precursor to the desired insulin analog, 697 mg of the Gly(A21) human proinsulin precursor were dissolved in 70 mL 50 mM ammonium bicarbonate, then chilled to 4°C., pH 8.3. A volume (0.14 mL) of a 1 mg/mL solution of pork trypsin (Sigma Chemical Company, St. Louis, Mo.) in 0.01 N HCl was added to the sample solution which was stirred gently at 4° C. for about 24 hours. An additional 0.14 mL of the trypsin solution was added to the reaction solution which was then stirred for an additional 21 hours, 45 minutes. The reaction was quenched by lowering the pH to 3.2 with 0.7 mL glacial acetic acid and 0.3 mL phosphoric acid. The quenched Gly(A21)Arg(B31)Arg(B32)-human insulin sample solution from the tryptic cleavage reaction was diluted 4× with 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid, pH 3.1, and loaded onto a 1×30 cm S HyperD F (Biosepra, Marlborough, Mass.) cation exchange column previously pumped with 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid/500 mM NaCl, pH 3.3, and equilibrated in 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid. Once loaded the column was pumped with about 50 mL of 30% acetonitrile/70% 50 mM acetic acid, then eluted with a linear gradient of NaCl in 30% acetonitrile/50 mM acetic acid while monitoring the eluant at 276 nm. Selected fractions containing the Gly(A21)Arg(B31)Arg(B32)-human insulin were pooled, diluted 3× with purified water and loaded onto a 2.2×25 cm C4 reversed-phase column (Vydac, Hesperia, Calif.) previously pumped with 60% acetonitrile/40% water/0.1% TFA, then 10% acetonitrile/90% water/0.1% TFA. Once loaded, the column was pumped with about 200 mL of 10% acetonitrile/90% water/0.1% TFA, then eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 0.1% TFA. Selected fractions were pooled and lyophilized giving a recovery of 101 mg. Analytical HPLC revealed a purity of greater that 95% main peak. Electrospray mass spectroscopy (ESMS) analysis of the purified protein yielded a molecular weight of 6062.9 (6063.0, theory).
  • Preparation 2 Des(B30)-human Insulin
  • Des(B30)-human insulin was prepared from human proinsulin by controlled tryptic hydrolysis. A mass (2 g) of human proinsulin biosynthesized in recombinant [0310] E. coli and purified by conventional methods [Frank, B. H., et al., in PEPTIDES: Synthesis-Structure-Function. Proceedings of the Seventh American Peptide Symposium, Rich, D. H. and Gross, E. (Eds.), Pierce Chemical Company, Rockford, pp. 729-738, 1981; also, Frank, B. H., U.S. Pat. No. 4,430,266, issued Feb. 7, 1984, each of which is incorporated by reference] were dissolved in 400 mL of 0.1 M, pH 7.5 HEPES buffer. After addition of 8 mL of 1 M CaCl2 (in water) and pH adjustment to 7.5 with 5 N NaOH, 2 mL of a 10 mg/mL solution of pork trypsin (Sigma) in 0.01 N HCl were transferred to the sample solution while gently stirring. The reaction solution was allowed to stir at ambient temperature for 2 hours and 42 minutes, at which time it was transferred to a 37° C. environment while stirring occasionally. After 1 hour and 45 minutes at 37° C. the enzymatic reaction was quenched by lowering the pH to 3.0 with phosphoric acid and the temperature to 4° C. for storage. Subsequently, the solution was brought to room temperature and diluted with 50 mL acetonitrile, then to a final volume of 500 mL with purified water, then loaded onto a 2.5×58 cm CG-161 (Toso-Haas) column previously pumped with 1 c.v. (column volume) of 40% acetonitrile/60% 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5, and 2 c.v. of 10% acetonitrile/90% 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5. Once loaded the column was pumped with 1 c.v. of 10% acetonitrile/90% 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5. The column was eluted with a linear gradient of acetonitrile in 0.1 M ammonium sulfate, pH 2.5, while monitoring the eluant at 276 nm. The peak of interest, partially purified des(B30)-human insulin, was collected by pooling selected fractions. This pooled sample of partially purified des(B30)-human insulin was diluted to 1.28 liters with purified water, pH 3.5, and applied to a 1×29 cm S HyperD F (Biosepra) cation exchange column previously pumped with 1 c.v. of 30% acetonitrile/70% 0.1% TFA/0.5 M NaCl, pH 1.9, and 2 c.v. of 30% acetonitrile/70% 0.1% TFA, pH 2.3. Once loaded the column was pumped with 1 c.v. 30% acetonitrile/70% 0.1% TFA, pH 2.3, then eluted with a linear gradient of NaCl in 30% acetonitrile/70% 0.1% TFA, pH 1.9 to 2.3, while monitoring the eluant at 276 nm. Selected fractions containing the purified des(B30)-human insulin were pooled, diluted 2.5× with purified water and loaded onto a 35-c.c. C8 SepPak (Waters, Milford, Mass.) previously cleaned and primed with 2 c.v. of acetonitrile, 2 c.v. of 60% acetonitrile/40% 0.1% TFA, and 2 c.v. of 10% acetonitrile/90% 0.1% TFA. Once loaded the SepPak was flushed with 3 c.v. of 10% acetonitrile/90% 0.1% TFA and then eluted with 2 c.v. of 60% acetonitrile/40% 0.1% TFA. The lyophilized eluant yielded 500 mg. An analytical HPLC assay suggested greater than 95% main peak. Electrospray mass spectroscopy (ESMS) analysis of the purified protein yielded a molecular weight of 5706.5 (5707, theory).
  • Preparation 3 Rabbit Insulin
  • Rabbit insulin was prepared as described in Chance, R. E., et al. [Proinsulin, Insulin, C-Peptide, Baba, S., et al. (Eds.), [0311] Excerpta Medica, Amsterdam-Oxford, pp. 99-105 (1979)].
  • Preparation 4 ASp(B28)-Human Insulin Analog
  • Asp(B28)-human insulin was prepared and purified essentially according to the teaching of examples 31 and 32 of Chance, R. B., et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 5,700,662, issued Dec. 23, 1997) which is expressly incorporated herein by reference. Des(B23-30)-human insulin [Bromer, W. W. and Chance, R. B., [0312] Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 133:219-223 (1967), which is incorporated herein by reference] and a synthetic octapeptide Gly-Phe-Phe-Tyr-Thr-Asp-Lys(Tfa)-Thr were condensed using trypsin-assisted semisynthesis, purified by gel filtration and reversed-phased HPLC, treated with 15% ammonium hydroxide (v/v) for four hours at ambient temperature to remove the trifluoroacetate (Tfa) blocking group from Lys(B29), purified by reversed-phase HPLC, and lyophilized.
  • Preparation 5 Syntheses of Derivatized Proteins
  • The following is an outline of the syntheses of certain derivatized proteins used to prepare the precipitates and crystals of the present invention. The outline is to be read together with the data in Table 2, below. [0313]
  • A measured mass of purified insulin or of an insulin analog was dissolved in a measured volume of dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) with stirring. Then, a measured volume of tetramethylguanidine hydrochloride (TMG) was added and the solution mixed thoroughly. In a separate container, a measured mass of an N-acyl-succinimide (NAB) was dissolved in a measured volume of DMSO. A measured volume of the second solution was added to the first solution. The reaction was carried out at room temperature, and the progress of the reaction was monitored by analyzing samples of the reaction mixture using HPLC. The reaction was quenched by adding a measured volume of ethanolamine, and then acidifying to pH 2-3. [0314]
  • The reaction mixture was then subjected to purification using reversed-phase chromatography alone, or using a combination of cation exchange chromatography followed by reversed-phase chromatography. The reversed-phase purification was carried out using an FPLC® system (Pharmacia) with UV detection at 214 nm or at 280 nm, a fraction collector, 2.2×25 cm or 5×30 cm C18 column, 2.5 or 5 mL/min flow rate, at room temperature. The liquid phases were mixtures of Solution A [0.1% trifluroacetic acid (TFA) in 10:90 acetonitrile:water (vol:vol)] and Solution B [0.1% trifluroacetic acid (TFA) in 70:30 acetonitrile:water (vol:vol)] appropriate to elute and separate the species of interest. Typically, the column was equilibrated and loaded while in 100% Solution A. Then, a linear gradient to some proportion of Solution B was used to separate the reaction products adequately. Fractions containing product were pooled. The development of purification methods is within the skill of the art. [0315]
  • Table 2 below provides experimental data, according to the outline above, for the synthesis of the derivatized proteins that were used to prepare various embodiments of the present invention. The starting proteins were prepared as described above, or according to conventional methods. Conventional purification was used to provide highly purified starting proteins for the syntheses described below. The synthesis of insulin, insulin analogs, and proinsulin is within the skill of the art, and may be accomplished using recombinant expression, semisythesis, or solid phase synthesis followed by chain combination. The purification of synthesized proteins to a purity adequate to prepare the derivatives used in the present invention is carried out by conventional purification techniques. [0316]
  • Molecular weight of the purified derivatives was confirmed by mass spectrometry via electrospray mass analysis (ESMS). Assignment of the acylation site was based either on a chromatographic analysis (“HPLC”), or on an N-terminal analysis (“N-terminal”), or both. [0317]
    TABLE 3
    Summary of synthesis of various derivatized
    proteins.
    Starting protein human insulin human insulin human insulin
    Protein mass 141.3 1,080 120
    (mg)
    DMSO (mL) 42 30 36
    TMG (μL) 30.5 233 25.9
    NAS acyl chain n-hexanoyl n-octanoyl n-dodecanoyl
    Mass of NAS 7.76 85.7 9.22
    (mg)
    Volume of 1.0 1.0 0.701
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.494 0.785 0.701
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 40 105 40
    (min)
    Ethanolamine 20 100 120
    volume (μL)
    Total yield (%) 40 33 36
    Mol. Wt. 5906.0 5933.9 5990.0
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 5906.8 5933.9 5990.0
    (ESMS)
    HPLC Purity 96 94 98
    (%)
    Acylation site
    (HPLC)
    Acylation site
    (N-terminal)
    Starting protein human insulin human insulin human insulin
    Protein mass 194 2040 2050
    (mg)
    DMSO (mL) 60 62 58
    TMG (μL) 41.9 441 443
    NAS acyl chain n- n-butyryl n-hexanoyl
    tetradecanoyl
    Mass of NAS 23.4 269.3 209
    (mg)
    Volume of 1.0 1.0 2.0
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.756 0.29 1.44
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 20 30 30
    (min)
    Ethanolamine 5 100 100
    volume (μL)
    Total yield 45 27* 22
    (%)
    Mol. Wt. 6.018.1 5877.8 5905.9
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 6018.1 5877.8 5906.0
    (ESMS)
    HPLC Purity 98 94 93
    (%)
    Acylation site
    (HPLC)
    Acylation site
    (N-terminal)
  • The following is an outline of the synthesis of additional derivatized proteins. The outline is to be read together with the data in Table 3, below, to provide full synthetic schemes. [0318]
  • A measured mass of purified insulin or of an insulin analog was dissolved by adding to it a measured volume of 50 mM boric acid, pH 2.57. A measured volume of acetonitrile, equal to the volume of boric acid solution, was then added slowly with stirring. The “solvent” volume is the sum of the volumes of the boric acid and acetonitrile. The pH of the solution was adjusted to between 10.2 and 10.5 using NaOH. In a separate container, a measured mass of an N-acyl-succinimide (“NAS”) was dissolved in a measured volume of DMSO. A measured volume of the second solution was added to the first solution. The reaction was carried out at room temperature, the pH was maintained above 10.2 as necessary, and the progress of the reaction was monitored by analyzing samples of the reaction mixture using HPLC. The reaction was quenched by acidifying to pH 2-3. The reaction mixture was then subjected to purification using a reversed-phase chromatography system as described above. [0319]
  • Table 3 provides experimental data, according to the outline above, for the synthesis of the derivatized proteins that were used to prepare various embodiments of the present invention. Molecular weight of the purified derivatives was confirmed by mass spectrometry via electrospray mass analysis (ESMS). Assignment of the acylation site was based either on a chromatographic analysis (“HPLC”), or on an N-terminal analysis (“N-terminal”), or both. [0320]
    TABLE 3
    Summary of synthesis of various derivatized
    proteins.
    Starting protein human insulin human insulin human insulin
    Protein mass 2,170 2,420 2,250
    (mg)
    Solvent (mL) 200 240 200
    NAS acyl chain n-butyryl n-pentanoyl n-octanoyl
    Mass of 108.7 1155 173
    N-acyl-
    succinimide
    (mg)
    Volume of 1.0 5 1.0
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.955 0.719 0.81
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 40 40 40
    (min)
    Total yield (%) 25 12 37
    Mol. Wt. 5877.8 5891.8 5933.9
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 5877.7 5891.9 5933.8
    (ms)
    HPLC Purity 96 95 96
    (%)
    Acylation site
    (HPLC)
    Starting protein human insulin human insulin human insulin
    Protein mass 1,960 2,750 1,040
    (mg)
    Solvent (mL) 200 200 200
    NAS acyl chain n-nonanoyl n-dodecanoyl n-
    tetradecanoyl
    Mass of 145.8 19.9 102.3
    N-acyl-
    succinimide
    (mg)
    Volume of 1.0 1.0 1.0
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.887 0.771 0.885
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 40 30 35
    (min)
    Total yield (%) 35 14 39
    Mol. Wt. 5947.9 5990.0 6018.1
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 5948.1 5989.9 6018.1
    (ms)
    HPLC Purity 94 93 94
    (%)
    Acylation site
    (HPLC)
    Starting protein sheep insulin beef insulin pork insulin
    Protein mass 312 275 200
    (mg)
    Solvent (mL) 100 100 100
    NAS acyl chain n-hexanoyl n-hexanoyl n-octanoyl
    Mass of 27.2 19.9 16.4
    N-acyl-
    succinimide
    (mg)
    Volume of 1.0 1.0 1.0
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.644 0.771 0.764
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 45 30 82
    (min)
    Total yield (%) 31 50 41
    Mol. Wt. 5801.7 5831.8 5903.9
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 5801.8 5831.7 5903.9
    (ms)
    HPLC Purity 96 96 96
    (%)
    Acylation site
    (HPLC)
    rabbit des (B30)- AsapB28-human
    Starting Protein insulin human insulin insulin
    Protein mass 211.4 205.3 132.3
    (mg)
    Solvent (mL) 100 20 20
    NAS acyl chain n-octanoyl n-octanoyl n-octanoyl
    Mass of 16.8 21.5 11.5
    N-acyl-
    succinimide
    (mg)
    Volume of 1.0 0.5 1.0
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.786 0.303 0.715
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 57 40 85
    (min)
    Total yield (%) 39 47 32
    Mol. Wt. 5919.9 5833.6 5951.9
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 5920.0 5832.7 5952.2
    (ms)
    HPLC Purity 95 96 94
    (%)
    Acylation site
    (HPLC)
    GlyA21,
    ArgB31,
    ArgB32-human des (B27)-
    insulin human insulin
    Starting protein analog human insulin analog
    Protein mass 86.2 134.8 44.8
    (mg)
    Solvent (mL) 100 20 7
    NAS acyl chain n-octanoyl n-methyl n-octanoyl
    hexanoyl
    Mass of 22.4 749 3.6
    N-acyl-
    succinimide
    (mg)
    Volume of 0.5 4.93* 1.0
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.115 0.052 0.993
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 40 45 40
    (min)
    Total yield (%) 45 45 53
    Mol. Wt. 6189.2 5919.9 5832.8
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 6189.2 5919.9 5832.9
    (ms)
    HPLC Purity 97 96 93
    (%)
    Acylation site
    (HPLC)
    *Dissolved in actenotrile instead of DMSO.
    Starting protein human insulin human insulin human insulin
    Protein mass 160 147.7 2,080
    (mg)
    Solvent (mL) 20 20 200
    NAS acyl chain n-methyl n-methyl n-octanoyl
    octanoyl hexanoyl
    Mass of 715 22.5 146.7
    N-acyl-
    succinimide
    (mg)
    Volume of 4.97* 1.0* 1.0*
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.0734 0.609 0.884
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 60 45 40
    (min)
    Total yield (%) 54 38 5.3**
    Mol. Wt. 5947.9 5976.0 6060.1
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 5947.8 5976.2 6060.5
    (ms)***
    HPLC Purity 96 96 92
    (%)
    Acylation site Al-Nα, Nε
    (HPLC)
    *Dissolved in acetonitrile instead of DMSO.
    **Yield of the Al-Nα, B29-Nε-diacyl-human insulin derivative
    ***Determined by Matrix-Assisted Laser Desorption Ionization (MALDI)
       mass spectroscopy instead of electrospray mass spectroscopy
    des (B30)-
    human insulin
    Starting protein analog human insulin human insulin
    Protein mass 205.3 1,960 2,110
    (mg)
    Solvent (mL) 20 200 200
    NAS acyl chain n-octanoyl n-nonanoyl n-decanoyl
    Mass of 21.5 145.8 150.5
    N-acyl-
    succinimide
    (mg)
    Volume of 1.0 1.0 1.0
    DMSO (mL)
    Volume of 0.089 0.0887 0.975
    NAS solution
    added (mL)
    Reaction time 40 40 60
    (min)
    Total yield (%) 11.0 11.5 11.1
    Mol. Wt. 5959.5 6088.2 6116.2
    (theory)
    Mol. Wt. 5959.3 6088.3 6116.4
    (ms)
    HPLC Purity 96 92 92
    (%)
    Acylation site al-Nα, Nε al-Nα, Nε Al-Nα, Nε
    (HPLC)
  • Preparation 6 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-LynB29 Human Insulin
  • A dry powder of B29-Nε-octanoyl-LysB29 human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6. To this solution is added 150 parts of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride. The pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH. Then 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is stirred slowly for 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.). The amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid. [0321]
  • Preparation 7 Formulation of Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-LysB29 Human Insulin
  • The microcrystals prepared by the method of Preparation 6 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods, such as, filtration, centrifugation, or decantation. The recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 25 mM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 7.4, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds to the equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin. [0322]
  • Preparation 8 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB29 Human Insulin
  • A dry powder of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB29 human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 MM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, 10 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol at pH 7.6. To this solution is added 150 parts of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride. The pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH. Then 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is stirred slowly for 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.). The amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid. [0323]
  • Preparation 9 Formulation of Microcrystals of B29-Rε-hexanoyl-LysB29 Human Insulin
  • The microcrystals prepared by the method of Preparation 8 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods. The recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 2 mg/mL sodium phosphate dibasic, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 6.8, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds approximately to the concentration equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin. [0324]
  • Preparation 10 Microcrystals of D28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human Insulin
  • A dry powder of B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6. To this solution is added 150 parts of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride. The pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH. Then 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. After 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.), the amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid. [0325]
  • Preparation 11 Formulation of Microcrystals of B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human Insulin
  • The microcrystals prepared by the method of [0326] Preparation 10 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods. The recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 25 MM TRIS, 5 mg/mL phenol, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 7.6, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds approximately to the concentration equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin.
  • Preparation 12 Microcrystals of B28-Nε-butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human Insulin
  • A dry powder of B29-Nε-butyryl-LysB29 human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 1000 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6. To this solution is added 150 parts of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride. The pH is adjusted to 7.6 with 1 N HCl and/or 1 N NaOH. Then 120 parts by volume of ethanol are added. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A second solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and of the protamine sulfate solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms. After 24 hours at room temperature (typically about 22° C.), the amorphous precipitate converts to a microcrystalline solid. [0327]
  • Preparation 13 Formulation of Microcrystals of B28-Nε-butyryl-LysB28, ProB29-human Insulin
  • The microcrystals prepared by the method of Preparation 7 are separated from the mother liquor and are recovered by conventional solid/liquid separation methods. The recovered microcrystals are then suspended in a solution consisting of 25 mM TRIS, 2.5 mg/mL m-cresol, and 16 mg/mL glycerol, pH 7.8, so that the final concentration of acylated insulin corresponds approximately to the concentration equivalent of a 100 U/mL solution of insulin. [0328]
  • Preparation 14 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-butyryl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-butyryl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0329] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-butyryl-human insulin (16.21 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of acrystallization diluent was added, and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. The crystallization diluent was prepared by dissolving in water, with stirring, 0.603 g of TRIS, 1.007 g of phenol, 1.582 g of glycerol and 2.947 g of trisodium citrate. Further water was added to bring the of the solution to 100 mL. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the crystallization diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.59 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To a volume of the filtered solution was added an equal volume of an aqueous solution of protamine, prepared by dissolving 18.59 mg of protamine sulfate in water to a final volume of 50 mL. The mixture of the two volumes was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Rod-like crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-butyryl-human insulin had a t½ of 32-33 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 15 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-pentanoyl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-pentanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0330] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-pentanoyl-human insulin (16.14 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. The procedure described in Preparation 14 was followed, except the pH was adjusted to 7.60, and the protamine solution contained 18.64 mg of protamine sulfate in a total volume of 50 mL. Rod-like crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-pentanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of 33-34 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 16 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0331] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-hexanoyl human insulin (15.87 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. The procedure described in Preparation 14 was followed, except the pH was adjusted to 7.58. Rod-like crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of 69-70 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 17 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-(2-methylhexanoyl)-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-(2-methylhexanoyl)-human insulin was prepared as described in [0332] Preparation 5. A mass (8.19 mg) of B29-Nε-(2-methylhexanoyl)-human insulin was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed thoroughly. Then, 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate) was added and mixed. The pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.61 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH, and then the solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2 mL of this filtered solution was added 2 mL of a protamine solution (in 100 mL, 37.41 mg of protamine). The mixture was swirled gently. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C. Rod-like crystals formed in good yield (greater than 65%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-2-methylhexanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of 23 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 18 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-LysB29 human insulin (4.17 mg) was dissolved in 1 mL of a solvent composed of 25 mM TRIS, 0.1 M trisodium citrate, and 10 mg/mL phenol at pH 7.6. To this solution, 0.15 mL of a 15.3 mM solution of zinc chloride was added. The resulting solution was adjusted to a pH of 7.6 with 1 N NaOH. To this solution 0.12 mL of ethanol was added. The resulting solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A second solution was prepared by dissolving 3.23 mg of protamine sulfate in 10 mL of water then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A volume 1 mL of the 329-Nε-octanoyl-LysB29 human insulin solution and 1 mL of the protamine sulfate solution were combined, resulting in the immediate appearance of an amorphous precipitate. This solution was divided into two 1 mL portions which were transferred to vials then gently agitated for 19 hours at room temperature (approximately 22° C.), using an automatic wrist-action shaker. This procedure resulted in the formation of a white-to-off-white microcrystalline solid. HPLC analysis of crystals that have been removed from the mother liquor and thoroughly washed demonstrated the presence of protamine within the crystalline material. [0333]
  • Preparation 19 Crystalline Suspension Formulation Comprising Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • An acidic solution of Nε-octanoyl-human insulin was prepared by dissolving 39.7 mg of Nε-octanoyl-human insulin in 1 mL of 0.1 N HCl. This solution was stirred for approximately 5 minutes. To this solution was added 0.4 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) with stirring. The zinc nitrate solution was 1:10 dilution of a 10,000 ppm Zn(II) atomic absorption standard. To the Nε-octanoyl-human insulin plus zinc solution was added 4 mL of a crystallization diluent (40 mg/ml glycerol, 50 mM TRIS, 4 mg/mL m-cresol, 1.625 mg/mL phenol, 100 mM trisodium citrate, pH 7.4). The pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.61. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low protein-binding filter. Five milliliters (5 mL) of protamine solution (37.6 mg of protamine sulfate in 50 mL of water) were added to 5 mL of the filtered Nε-octanoyl-human insulin solution. The solution was allowed to stand undisturbed for 63 hours at a controlled temperature of 25° C. [0334]
  • Microscopic inspection (at 63 hours) revealed that crystallization had occurred and that the preparation had yielded uniform, single, rod-like crystals possessing approximate average lengths of about 10 microns. [0335]
  • The crystals were sedimented by allowing the formulation to stand undisturbed. Eight milliliters (8 mL) of the supernatant were then removed, and were replaced with 8 mL of a diluent [16 mg/mL glycerol, 20 mM TRIS, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, 40 mM trisodium citrate, pH 7.4]. The crystals were then resuspended. This procedure was carried out in the same way three times, except that on the third occasion, the 8 mL of supernatant was replaced with 7 mL of diluent. [0336]
  • The amount of insulins in the formulation was analyzed by HPLC to quantitate the total potency. The total potency refers to the total concentration of human insulin and Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin. An aliquot (0.050 mL) of the fully resuspended formulation was dissolved in 0.950 mL of 0.01 N HCL, and subjected to HPLC analysis, as described below. For HPLC analyses, the following conditions were used: a C8-reversed-phase column; constant 23° C.; 1.0 mL/min, detection at 214 nm; solvent A=10% acetonitrile (vol/vol) in 0.1% aqueous trifluoroacetic acid; solvent B=90% acetonitrile (vol/vol) in 0.1% aqueous trifluoroacetic acid; linear gradients (0.1 min, 0% B; 45.1 min, 75% B; 50.1 min, 100% B; 55 min 100% B; 57 min, 0% B; 72 min, 0% B). Standards were prepared by dissolving bulk insulin and bulk acyl insulin in 0.01 N HCl. The concentration of each standard was determined by UV spectroscopy. A solution of 1.000 mg/mL of human insulin in a 1 cm cuvette was assumed to have an absorbance of 1.05 optical density units at the wavelength maximum (approximately 276 nm). This corresponds to a molar extinction coefficient of 6098. Acylated insulins were assumed to have the same molar extinction coefficient as human insulin. The solutions calibrated by UV were then diluted to get standards at 0.220, 0.147, 0.073, and 0.022 mg/mL. The standards were run on HPLC and a standard curve of area vs. concentration was obtained. [0337]
  • Total potency of Nε-octanoyl-human insulin in the crystal formulation was 3.76 mg/mL. The concentration of soluble Nε-octanoyl-human insulin was determined to be 0.01 mg/mL. No unacylated human insulin was found by HPLC analysis. [0338]
  • The dissolution rate of the crystals was measured by placing 0.005 mL of the uniformly suspended formulation into 3 mL of Dulbecco's phosphate buffered saline (without calcium or magnesium) in a 1 cm path length square quartz cuvette at a temperature of 22° C. This solution was stirred at a constant rate using a magnetic cuvette stirrer. Absorbance measurements at 320 nm were taken at 1 minute intervals. The absorbance at 320 nm corresponds to the light scattered by the insoluble particles present in the aqueous suspension. Consequently, as the microcrystals dissolve, the absorbance approaches zero. The approximate time required for the 0.005 mL of this formulation to dissolve was more than 400 minutes. The time required for a 0.005 mL sample of U100 commercial Humulin® N to dissolve under the same conditions was about 10 minutes. [0339]
  • Particle size measurement was performed on a sample of the formulation utilizing a particle sizing instrument (Multisizer Model IIE, Coulter Corp., Miami, Fla., 33116-9015). To perform this measurement, 0.25 mL of the crystal formulation was added to 100 mL of a diluent consisting 14 mM dibasic sodium phosphate, 16 mM glycerol, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, pH 7.4. The instrument aperture tube orifice size was 50 microns. Particle size data were collected for 50 seconds. The mean particle diameter of the crystals was approximately 6 microns, with an approximately normal distribution, encompassing a range of particle sizes from approximately 2 &microns to approximately 12 microns. This result is similar to the particle size distribution of commercial NPH as reported in DeFelippis, M. R., et al., [0340] J. Pharmaceut. Sci. 87:170-176 (1998).
  • Preparation 20 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-nonanoyl-human Insulin
  • Nε-nonanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0341] Preparation 5. A sample of Nε-nonanoyl-human insulin (16.16 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. The procedure described in Preparation 14 was followed, except the protamine solution contained 18.64 mg of protamine sulfate in a total volume of 50 mL. Rod-like crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-nonanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of 83 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 21 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin
  • B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin was prepared essentially as described in [0342] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin (60.7 mg) was dissolved in 1.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. A volume (0.6 ml) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and mixed thoroughly. To 0.7 mL of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 2.0 mL of diluent “A” (50 MM citrate, 5 mg/mL phenol, 16 mg/mL glycerol, 25 MM TRIS, pH 7.6). To another 0.7 mL portion of the zinc-derivatized protein solution was added 2.0 mL of diluent ° “B” (100 mM citrate, 2 mg/mL phenol, 50 mM TRIS, pH 7.6). The pH in the vials was adjusted to 7.62 and 7.61, respectively, and each was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. A volume of the contents of vial A (2.5 mL) was mixed with 2.5 mL of a protamine sulfate solution (7.4 mg protamine sulfate dissolved in 10 mL of diluent A). A cloudy precipitate developed immediately. The preparation was allowed to stand undisturbed at 25° C. Likewise, a volume of the contents of vial B (2.5 mL) was mixed with 2.5 mL of a protamine sulfate solution (37.8 mg protamine sulfate dissolved in 50 mL of water). A cloudy precipitate developed immediately. The preparation was allowed to stand undisturbed at 25° C. Microscopic examination of the contents of both vials after 60 hours revealed that small crystals had formed in both. A rod-like morphology was clearly evident for the crystals in vial B. The yield of crystals in vial B was determined by HPLC to be 80%. In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin in vial B had a t½ of 70 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 22 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-dodecanoyl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-dodecanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0343] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-dodecanoyl-human insulin (17.00 mg) was dissolved in 4.0 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 8.47). The pH of the solution of the insulin analog derivative was adjusted to 8.57 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH. To the pH-adjusted solution was added 0.320 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II). The pH of the zinc-insulin analog derivative solution was adjusted to 7.59 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2.0 mL of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 0.25 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently. To another 2.0 mL volume of the resulting solution in “Vial B” was added 0.6 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently. To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 2.0 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, each vial contained a cloudy suspension. Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Small, irregular crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-dodecanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 23 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-tetradecanoyl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-tetradecanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0344] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-tetradecanoyl-human insulin (16.42 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 7.58), and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted first to 7.9, and then back to 7.59, using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 1.97 mL of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 0.246 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently. To another 1.97 mL volume of the resulting solution in “Vial B” were added 0.591 mL of ethanol, which resulted in the formation of a haziness in the vial. The mixture was mixed gently. To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 1.97 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, each vial contained a cloudy suspension. Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Small, irregular crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-tetradecanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 24 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-hexadecanoyl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-hexadecanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0345] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-hexadecanoyl-human insulin (16.29 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 7.58), and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted first to 8.0, and then back to 7.61, using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2.0 ml of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 0.25 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently. To another 2.0 mL volume of the resulting solution in “Vial B” were added 0.6 mL of ethanol, which resulted in the formation of a haziness in the vial. The mixture was mixed gently. To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 2.0 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, each vial contained a cloudy suspension. Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Crystals formed in both vials. Small, irregular crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-hexadecanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 25 Microcrystals of A1-Nα-octanoyl-B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • A mass (8.13 mg) of A1-Nα-octanoyl-B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin analog was dissolved in 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL; 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate). The pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.61 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 ml of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed again thoroughly. The pH was adjusted again, to 7.62, and then the solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2 mL of this filtered solution was added 2 mL of a protamine solution (in 100 mL, 37.41 mg of protamine). The mixture was swirled gently. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C. Small irregular crystals formed. [0346]
  • Preparation 26 Microcrystals of A1-Nα-octanoyl-B29-Nε-Octanoyl-desB30-human Insulin
  • The process of Preparation 25 was followed essentially, except that 8.08 mg of A1-Nα-octanoyl-B29-Nε-octanoyl-desB30-human insulin was used. Small irregular crystals formed. [0347]
  • Preparation 27 Microcrystals of A1-Nα-nonanoyl-B29-Nε-nonanoyl-desB30-human Insulin
  • The process of Preparation 25 was followed essentially, except that 8.07 mg of A1-Nα-nonanoyl-B29-Nε-nonanoyl-desB30-human insulin was used. Small irregular crystals formed. [0348]
  • Preparation 28 Microcrystals of A1-Nα-decanoyl-B29-Nε-decanoyl-desB30-human Insulin
  • The process of Preparation 25 was followed essentially, except that 8.22 mg of A1-Nα-decanoyl-B29-Nε-decanoyl-desB30-human insulin was used. Small irregular crystals formed. [0349]
  • Preparation 29 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-Gly(A21), Arg(B31), Arg(B32)-human Insulin Analog
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-Gly(A21), Arg(B31), Arg(B32)-human insulin analog was prepared as described in [0350] Preparation 5. A mass (8.6 mg) of B29-Nε-octanoyl-Gly(A21), Arg(B31), Arg(B32)-human insulin analog was dissolved in 0.4 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed again thoroughly. Then, 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate) was added and mixed by additional stirring. The pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.59 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH, and then the solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2 mL of this filtered solution was added 2 mL of a protamine solution (in 100 mL, 37.41 mg of protamine). The mixture was swirled gently. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C. Small irregular crystals formed.
  • Preparation 30 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(ThrB30) -human insulin was prepared as described in [0351] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin (16.21 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 7.58), and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted first to 8.45 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH, as needed. This failed to completely clarify the solution. The pH was then adjusted to 7.61, using small aliquots of 1 N HCl, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To a volume of the filtered solution was added an equal volume of an aqueous solution of protamine (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, a cloudy suspension developed. The suspension was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Rod-like crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin had a t½ of 94 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 31 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(B30)-human Insulin Analog
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin was prepared as described in [0352] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(ThrB30)-human insulin (8.09 mg) was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.16 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(XI) was added and the resulting solution was mixed thoroughly. Then, 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate) was added and mixed. The pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.61 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH, and then the solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2 mL of this filtered solution was added 2 mL of a protamine solution (in 100 mL, 37.41 mg of protamine). The mixture was swirled gently. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C.
  • Preparation 32 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-beef Insulin
  • B29-Nε-hexanoyl-beef insulin was prepared as described in [0353] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-beef insulin (16.14 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of crystallization diluent (containing, per mL, 10 mg phenol, 16 glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.0 mg TRIS, in water, pH unadjusted) was added, and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the crystallization diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.58 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To a volume of the filtered solution was added an equal volume of an aqueous solution of protamine (0.375 mg protamine sulfate/mL solution, in water, pH not adjusted). The mixture of the two volumes was swirled gently to complete mixing. A cloudy suspension formed, which was gently swirled to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Rod-like crystals formed in very high yield (greater than 90%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-beef insulin had a t½ of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 33 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-sheep Insulin
  • B29-N[0354] ε-hexanoyl-sheep insulin was prepared as described in Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-sheep insulin (16.15 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. The solution was hazy, and the addition of 0.1 mL 0.1 N HCl did not cause the haze to disperse completely. The procedure of Preparation 32 was followed thereafter, except that the pH was adjusted to 7.61 instead of 7.58. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-sheep insulin had a t½ of 184 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 34 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-pork Insulin
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-pork insulin was prepared as described in [0355] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-octanoyl-pork insulin (16.78 mg) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 8.5), and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted first to 8.4 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH was then adjusted to 7.60, using small aliquots of 1 N HCl, as needed. After this, the procedure of Preparation 32 was followed. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-pork insulin had a t½ of greater than 300 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 35 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-rabbit Insulin
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-rabbit insulin was prepared as described in [0356] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-octanoyl-rabbit insulin (8.10 mg) was dissolved in 0.25 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.16 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 1.6 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 8.5), and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted first to 8.34 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pR was then adjusted to 7.57, using small aliquots of 1 N HCl, as needed. After this, the procedure of Preparation 32 was followed. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-rabbit insulin had a t½ of 119 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 36 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(B27)-human Insulin Analog
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(B27)-human insulin analog was prepared as described in [0357] Preparation 5. A mass (8.02 mg) of B29-Nε-octanoyl-des(B27)-human insulin analog was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed thoroughly. Then, 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate) was added and mixed. The pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.61 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH, and then the solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2 mL of this filtered solution was added 2 mL of a protamine solution (in 100 mL, 37.41 mg of protamine). The mixture was swirled gently. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C. After six days, well-formed, single, rod-shaped crystals formed.
  • Preparation 37 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-Asp(B28)-human Insulin Analog
  • A mass (8.16 mg) of B29-Nε-octanoyl-Asp(B28)-human Insulin analog was dissolved in 1.60 mL of diluent (in 100 mL: 0.604 g TRIS, 1.003 g phenol, 3.218 g glycerol, and 3.069 g trisodium citrate). The pH of this solution was adjusted to 7.61 with small quantities of 1.0 N HCl and 1.0 N NaOH. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, 0.160 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added and the resulting solution was mixed again thoroughly. The pH was adjusted again, to 7.62, and then the solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2 mL of this filtered solution was added 2 mL of a protamine solution (in 100 mL, 37.41 mg of protamine). The mixture was swirled gently. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-N[0358] ε-octanoyl-Asp(B28)-human insulin analog had a t½ of 15 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 38 Microcrystals of B28-Nε-butryl-LysB28, ProB29-human Insulin
  • B28-Nε-butryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in [0359] Preparation 5. A sample of B28-Nε-butryl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.09 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. After stirring for 5-10 minutes, a volume (0.32 mL) of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, and the resulting solution was thoroughly mixed by stirring. Then, 3.2 mL of crystallization diluent was added, and the resulting mixture was stirred until completely mixed. (The crystallization diluent was prepared by dissolving in water, with stirring, 0.603 g of TRIS, 1.007 g of phenol, 1.582 g of glycerol and 2.947 g of trisodium citrate. Further water was added to bring the of the solution to 100 mL.) After mixing the zinc-insulin derivative solution with the crystallization diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.60 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH, as needed. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To a volume of the filtered solution was added an equal volume of an aqueous solution of protamine, prepared by dissolving 18.64 mg of protamine sulfate in water to a final volume of 50 mL. The mixture of the two volumes was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C.
  • Preparation 39 Microcrystals of B28-Nε-hexanoyl-Lys328, ProB29-human Insulin
  • B28-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in [0360] Preparation 5. A sample of B28-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (15.95 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. The procedure of Preparation 38 was subsequently followed. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B28-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin had a t½ of 5-6 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 40 Microcrystals of B28-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human Insulin
  • B28-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in [0361] Preparation 5. A sample of B28-Nε-hexanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.8 mg) was dissolved in 4.0 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 7.58). The pH of the solution of the insulin analog derivative was adjusted to 8.4 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH. To the pH-adjusted solution was added 0.320 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II). The pH of the zinc-insulin analog derivative solution was adjusted to 7.61 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2.0 mL of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 0.25 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently, and the solution became hazy. To another 2.0 mL volume of the resulting solution in “Vial B” was added 0.6 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently, and solution became hazy. To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 2.0 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, each vial contained a cloudy suspension. Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Crystals formed in both vials. The composition of the solution in Vial A was analyzed for the remaining concentration of insulin analog derivative, and the crystals were subjected to dissolution testing.
  • Preparation 41 Microcrystals of B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human Insulin
  • B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in [0362] Preparation 5. A sample of B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.02 mg) was dissolved in 0.8 mL of 0.1 N HCl. Hereafter, the procedure of Preparation 38 was followed essentially. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin had a t½ of 7-8 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 42 Microcrystals of B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin
  • B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared as described in [0363] Preparation 5. A sample of B28-Nε-octanoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (16.35 mg) was dissolved in 4.0 mL of diluent (containing in an aqueous solution, per mL of solution, 10 mg phenol, 32 mg glycerol, 30 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, and 6.1 mg TRIS, pH 7.58). The pH of the solution of the insulin analog derivative was adjusted to 8.4 using small aliquots of 1 N NaOH. To the pH-adjusted solution was added 0.320 mL of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II). The pH of the zinc-insulin analog derivative solution was adjusted to 7.62 using small aliquots of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH. The pH-adjusted solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. To 2.0 mL of the resulting solution in “Vial A” was added 0.25 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently, and the solution became hazy. To another 2.0 mL volume of the resulting solution in “Vial B” was added 0.6 mL of ethanol. The mixture was mixed gently, and solution became hazy. To the contents of both Vial A and Vial B were added 2.0 mL of a protamine solution (containing, dissolved in water, 0.376 mg protamine per mL). After adding the protamine solution, each vial contained a cloudy suspension. Each vial was swirled gently to complete mixing, and then allowed to stand at 25° C. Crystals formed in both vials. The composition of the solution in Vial A was analyzed for the remaining concentration of insulin analog derivative, and the crystals were subjected to dissolution testing. Small, irregular crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-rabbit insulin had a t½ of 15 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • Preparation 43 Amorphous Suspension of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin was prepared as described in [0364] Preparation 5. A sample of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (20.31 mg of solid, containing 16.95 mg protein) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. Then 200 microliters of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) was added, followed by 2.0 rnL of a diluent containing per mL: 1.625 mg phenol, 4 mg m-cresol, 40 mg glycerol, 5 mg anhydrous sodium dibasic phosphate, and 7.5 mg trisodium citrate dihydrate, with a final pH of 7.6. After adding the diluent, the pH of the resulting solution was adjusted to 7.58 with 0.090 mL of 1 N NaOH. The solution was then passed through a 0.22 micron, low-protein-binding sterile filter, and refrigerated overnight. At this point, the concentration of the insulin derivative was 6.074 mg/mL. The next morning, the solution had no visible precipitate. A volume of the solution (2.50 mL) was mixed with 2.875 mL of a protamine sulfate solution containing per mL 0.75 mg of solid protamine sulfate in water, and an amorphous precipitate immediately formed. The concentration of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin was 2.825 mg/mL after adding protamine. The suspension was injected into two dogs approximately 1 hour and forty minutes after mixing the insulin derivative with protamine.
  • Preparation 44 Amorphous Suspension of B28-Nε-myristoyl-LyoB28, ProB29 Human Insulin Analog
  • B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin was prepared essentially as described in [0365] Preparation 5. A sample of B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin (20.43 mg of solid, 18.53 mg of protein) was dissolved in 0.5 mL of 0.1 N HCl. Then 200 microliters of a zinc nitrate solution containing 1000 parts-per-million (ppm) zinc(II) and 2.0 mL of formulation diluent were added. The formulation diluent contained, per mL: 1.6 mg phenol, 4 mg m-cresol, 40 mg glycerol, 5 mg anhydrous sodium dibasic phosphate, and 7.5 mg trisodium phosphate dihydrate, with a final pH of 7.6. The pH of the formulation was adjusted from 5.9 to 8.7 with 100 microliters of 1 N NaOH. The formulation was clear. The pH was then reduced to 7.59 by adding 20 microliters of 1 N HCl. At this point, the protein concentration was 6.57 mg/mL. The solution was filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding sterile filter and refrigerated overnight. The next morning, the formulation had no visible precipitate present. A portion of the solution (2.50 mL) was mixed with 2.875 mL of protamine solution (0.75 mg/mL of solid protamine sulfate dissolved in water) and an amorphous suspension formed. The concentration of B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin would have been reduced to 3.056 mg/mL by the addition of the protamine solution. Samples for HPLC analysis were prepared promptly after the protamine was added. Based on known peak retention times, the HPLC analysis showed that the insoluble material contained protamine and B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin. The concentration of B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin in the supernatant was found to be 0.005 mg/mL, and in a sample of the precipitate re-dissolved to the original volume, the concentration was 3.13 mg/mL. The concentration of B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin in a sample of acidified suspension was 3.34 mg/mL.
  • Preparation 45 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • A dry powder of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 175 parts by volume of 0.1 N HCl, and then a solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mm concentration of zinc) is added. To this solution is added 800 parts by volume of an aqueous solvent comprising 25 mM TRIS, 10 mg/mL phenol, 0.1 M citrate, 40 mg/mL glycerol, in water at pH value 7.6. The resulting solution is adjusted to pH value of 7.6, and then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. [0366]
  • An additional solution is prepared by dissolving 7 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water. The protamine solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the derivatized protein solution and the protamine solution are combined by adding the protamine solution to the acylated insulin solution. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 48 hours at a temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin. [0367]
  • Preparation 46 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • The process of Preparation 45 is followed. The suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 48 hours at a temperature of 30° C. Similar results are obtained. [0368]
  • Preparation 47 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • A dry powder of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 175 parts by volume of 0.1 N HCl, and then a solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc) is added. To this solution is added 1000 parts by mass of an aqueous solvent comprising 35 mM sodium phosphate dibasic, 4 mg/mL m-cresol, 1.6 mg/mL phenol, 25 mM citrate, and 40 mg/mL glycerol, in water, pH 7.6. The resulting solution is adjusted to pH 7.6, and then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. [0369]
  • An additional solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the derivatized insulin solution and the protamine solution are combined by adding the protamine solution to the acylated protein solution. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 1 week at a temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin. [0370]
  • Preparation 48 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • A dry powder of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is dissolved in 175 parts by volume of 0.1 N HCl, and then a solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume, prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc) is added. To this solution is added 1000 parts by mass of a solvent comprising 35 mM sodium phosphate dibasic, 4 mg/mL m-cresol, 1.6 mg/mL phenol, 10 mm citrate, 40 mg/mL glycerol, in water, pH 7.6. The resulting solution is adjusted to pH 7.6, and then filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. [0371]
  • An additional solution is prepared by dissolving 6 parts by mass of protamine sulfate in 10,000 parts by volume of water then filtering through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the acylated insulin solution and the protamine solution are combined by adding the protamine solution to the acylated insulin solution. An amorphous precipitate forms. This suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 1 week at a temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin. [0372]
  • Preparation 49 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • The process of Preparation 47 is followed. The suspension is allowed to stand undisturbed for 60 hours at a temperature of 30° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin, [0373]
  • Preparation 50 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • A solution is prepared by adding to water for injection (WFI, 1000 parts by volume): phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass). Protamine sulfate powder (0.6 parts by mass) is then dissolved in this solution. A solution of zinc chloride (60 parts by volume) prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 15.3 mM concentration of zinc in 0.1 N HCl is then added. A dry powder of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is added and dissolved with stirring. The pH is adjusted to about 3 to aid dissolution if necessary with small quantities of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH. The pH is then adjusted to within the range 3-3.6 with small quantities of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. [0374]
  • A second solution is prepared by dissolving sodium phosphate dibasic (7.56 parts by mass), phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass) in water for injection (1000 parts by volume). The pH of this solution is adjusted to a value such that combination of a volume of this solution with an equal volume of the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin solution results in a pH value of about 7.5 to about 7.7. After appropriately adjusting the pH of this buffer solution, it is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of the buffer solution and the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms immediately which becomes crystalline upon standing for 60 hours undisturbed at a controlled temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin. [0375]
  • Preparation 51 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin
  • A solution is prepared by adding to water for injection (1000 parts by volume) sodium phosphate dibasic (3.78 parts by mass), phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass). A solution of zinc chloride (6 parts by volume) prepared by dissolving zinc oxide in HCl to give a 153 mM concentration of zinc in 0.1 N HCl is then added. A dry powder of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (7 parts by mass) is added and dissolved with stirring. The pH is adjusted to about 3 to aid dissolution if necessary with small quantities of 1 N HCl and 1 N NaOH. The pH is then adjusted to 7.6 with 10% HCl and 10% NaOH. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. [0376]
  • A second solution is prepared by dissolving sodium phosphate dibasic (3.78 parts by mass), phenol (0.65 parts by mass), m-cresol (1.6 parts by mass) and glycerin (16 parts by mass) in water for injection (1000 parts by volume). Protamine sulfate powder (0.6 parts by mass) is then dissolved in this solution. The pH of this solution is adjusted to 7.6. This solution is filtered through a 0.22 micron, low-protein binding filter. Equal volumes of this protamine solution and the B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin solution are combined. An amorphous precipitate forms immediately which becomes crystalline upon standing for 60 hours undisturbed at a controlled temperature of 25° C. The microcrystals in the resulting preparation will provide extended and flatter time action compared with an equal dose of NPH human insulin. [0377]
  • Preparation 52 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-(2-ethylhexanoyl)-human Insulin
  • B29-Nε-(2-ethylhexanoyl)-human insulin was prepared as described in [0378] Preparation 5. A mass (8.00 mg) of B29-Nε-(2-ethylhexanoyl)-human insulin was dissolved in 0.400 mL of 0.1 N HCl. Thereafter, the procedure of Preparation 17 was followed essentially. A precipitate formed. The mixture was left undisturbed at 25° C. Rod-like crystals formed in high yield (greater than 80%). In the spectrophotometric dissolution assay described above, the crystals of B29-Nε-2-ethylhexanoyl-human insulin had a t½ of 34-35 minutes, compared with about 6 minutes for Humulin® N in the same assay.
  • EXAMPLE 1 In Vivo Testing in Diabetic Dogs
  • The protracted action of a suspension formulation containing microcrystals prepared as described in any of Preparations herein is tested in diabetic dogs by comparing its ability to control hyperglycemia with that of control compounds. A one-per-day dose of about 0.2 units/kg of body weight is used. This dose would be equivalent to about 1.2 nmol/kg. On test days, blood glucose is monitored for 24 hours following subcutaneous injection of the suspension formulation. Control compounds are human insulin and NPH human insulin. Suspension formulations of microcrystals of the present invention will reduce blood glucose levels and will have an extended time action compared with human insulin NPH when tested at comparable doses. [0379]
  • EXAMPLE 2 Time-Action of Crystals in Rats
  • To 1.898 mL of the crystal formulation prepared according to Preparation 19 was added 3.102 mL of a diluent (16 mg/mL glycerol, 20 mM TRIS, 1.6 mg/mL m-cresol, 0.65 mg/mL phenol, 40 mM trisodium citrate, pH 7.4). This provided 5 mL of a U40 formulation, which was tested in BBDP/Wor rats, a genetically-characterized animal model, maintained by, and available from, the University of Massachusetts Medical Center (Worchester, Mass.) in connection with Biomedical Research Models, Inc. (Rutland, Mass.). The DPBB/Wor rat line is diabetes-prone, and exhibits insulin-dependent (autoimmune) diabetes mellitus. [0380]
  • Forty BBDP/Wor rats [20 male/20 female, aged 4-5 months, maintained on a long-acting insulin (PZI)], were randomly assigned by gender to eight experimental groups, A, B, C, D, E, F, G, and H. Groups A (5 males) and B (5 females) were treated for two days with a U40 human insulin ultralente composition having 2.5 mg/mL zinc. Groups C (5 males) and D (5 females) were treated for two days with a U40 human insulin ultralente composition having 1.25 mg/mL zinc. Groups E (5 males) and F (5 females) were treated for two days with a U40 beef-pork PZI insulin (PZI). Groups G (5 males) and H (5 females) were treated for two days with a crystal formulation according to the present invention, as described in this example. Each rat was given daily injections of its group's formulation for the two days before blood glucose was determined, and on the day that the blood glucose was determined. [0381]
  • Blood was obtained half an hour before administering the test formulations. Animals were injected subcutaneously with either 0.9 U/100 g body weight (males) or 1.1 U/100 g body weight (females) at 11:30 A.M. Blood was obtained by nicking the tail (not anaesthetized), stored briefly on ice, centrifuged, and glucose determined using a Beckman II glucose analyzer. Blood samples were obtained just prior to administering the test formulations, and at 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 hours after administration. The crystal formulations of the present invention controlled blood glucose for a time comparable to that obtained with the long-acting insulin preparations. [0382]
  • EXAMPLE 3 Time-Action of Crystals in Rats
  • The testing procedure described above in Example 2 was repeated with a second 5 mL sample of a U40 formulation of a suspension, prepared as described above. [0383]
  • Thirty-five BBDP/Wor rats [18 male/17 female, age 4-5 months, maintained on a long-acting insulin (PZI)], were randomly assigned by gender to six experimental groups, I, J, K, L, M, and N. Groups I (8 males) and J (8 females) were treated for three days with the crystal formulation according to the present invention, as described in this example, above. Groups K (5 males) and L (4 females) were treated for three days with a U40 human insulin ultralente composition having 2.5 mg/mL zinc. Groups M (5 males) and N (5 females) were treated for three days with a U40 beef-pork PZI insulin (PZI). Each rat was given daily injections of its group's formulation for the three days before blood glucose was determined, and on the day that the blood glucose was determined. [0384]
  • Blood was obtained half an hour before administering the test formulations. Animals were injected subcutaneously with either 0.9 U/100 g body weight (males) or 1.1 U/100 g body weight (females) at 11:30 A.M. Blood was obtained by nicking the tail (not anaesthetized), stored briefly on ice, centrifuged, and glucose determined using a Beckman II glucose analyzer. Blood samples were obtained just prior to administering the test formulations, and at 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 hours after administration. The crystal formulations of the present invention controlled blood glucose for a time comparable to that obtained with the long-acting insulin preparations. [0385]
  • EXAMPLE 4 Time-Action of Crystals in Rats
  • Twenty-six BBDP/Wor rats [13 male/13 female, age 4-6 months, maintained on a long-acting, protamine zinc insulin (PZI)], were randomly assigned by gender to four experimental groups, O, P, Q, and R. Groups O (8 males) and P (8 females) were treated for three days with the crystal formulation according to the present invention, as described in Example 2. Groups Q (5 males) and R (5 females) were treated for three days with a U-40 beef-pork PZI insulin (PZI). Each rat was given daily injections of its group's formulation for the three days before blood glucose was determined, and on the day that the blood glucose was determined. [0386]
  • Blood was obtained half an hour before administering the test formulations. Animals were injected subcutaneously with either 0.9 U/100 g body weight (males) or 1.1 U/100 g body weight (females) at 11:30. Blood was obtained by nicking the tail (not anaesthetized), stored briefly on ice, centrifuged, and glucose determined using a Beckman II glucose analyzer. Blood samples were obtained just prior to administering the test formulations, and at 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 hours after administration. The crystal formulations of the present invention controlled blood glucose for a time comparable to that obtained with the long-acting insulin preparations. [0387]
  • EXAMPLE 5 Amorphous Precipitate of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin Tested in Dogs
  • The time action of a formulation containing an amorphous precipitate of protamine and B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin, prepared as described in Preparation 43, was determined in two normal dogs (2 nmol/kg, subcutaneous). The dogs received a constant infusion of somatostatin to create a transient diabetic state. The data were compared with those observed in the same model after administration of human insulin ultralente (3 nmol/kg, n=5), and with saline (n=6). [0388]
  • Experiments were conducted in overnight-fasted, chronically-cannulated, conscious male and female beagles weighing 10-17 kg (Marshall Farms, North Rose, N.Y.). At least ten days prior to the study, animals were anesthetized with isoflurane (Anaquest, Madison, Wis.), and silicone catheters attached to vascular access ports (V-A-P®, Access Technologies, Norfolk Medical, Skokie, Ill.) were inserted into the femoral artery and femoral vein. The catheters were filled with a glycerol/heparin solution (3:1, v/v; final heparin concentration of 250 kIU/mL; glycerol from Sigma Chemical Co., St. Louis, Mo., and heparin from Elkins-Sinn, Inc., Cherry Hill, N.J.) to prevent catheter occlusion, and the wounds were closed. Kefzol (Eli Lilly & Co., Indianapolis, Ind.) was administered pre-operatively (20 mg/kg, IV and 20 mg/kg, I.M.), and Keflex was administered post-operatively (250 mg, p.o. once daily for seven days) to prevent infections. Torbugesic (1.5 mg/kg, I.M.) was administered post-operatively to control pain. [0389]
  • Blood was drawn just prior to the study day to determine the health of the animal. Only animals with hematocrits above 38% and leukocyte counts below 16,000/mm[0390] 3 were used (hematology analyzer: Cell-Dyn 900, Sequoia-Turner, Mountain View, Calif.).
  • The morning of the experiment, the ports were accessed (Access Technologies, Norfolk Medical, Skokie, Ill.; the contents of the catheters were aspirated; the catheters were flushed with saline (Baxter Healthcare Corp., Deerfield, Ill.); the dog was placed in a cage; and extension lines (protected by a stainless steel tether and attached to a swivel system [Instech Laboratories, Plymouth Meeting, Pa.]) were attached to the port access lines. [0391]
  • Dogs were allowed at least 10 minutes to acclimate to the cage environment before an arterial blood sample was drawn for determination of fasting insulin and blood glucose concentrations (time=−30 minutes). At this time, a continuous, IV infusion of cyclic somatostatin (0.65 μg/kg/min; BACHEM California, Torrance, Calif.) was initiated and continued for the next 30.5 hours. Thirty minutes after the start of infusion (time=0 minutes), an arterial blood sample was drawn, and a subcutaneous bolus of test substance, or vehicle, was injected in the dorsal aspect of the neck. Arterial blood samples were taken every 3 hours thereafter for the determination of plasma glucose and insulin concentrations. [0392]
  • Arterial blood samples were collected in vacuum blood collection tubes containing disodium EDTA (Terumo Medical Corp., Elkton, Md.) and immediately placed on ice. The samples were centrifuged, and the resulting plasma was transferred to polypropylene test tubes and stored on ice for the duration of the study. [0393]
  • Plasma glucose concentrations were determined the day of the study using a glucose oxidase method in a Beckman glucose analyzer (Beckman Instruments, Inc., Brea, Calif.). Samples for other assays were stored at −80° C. until time for analysis. Insulin concentrations were determined using a double antibody radioimmunoassay. [0394]
  • At the conclusion of the experiment, the catheters were flushed with fresh saline, treated with Kefzol (20 mg/kg), and filled with the glycerol/heparin mixture; antibiotic (Keflex; 250 mg) was administered p.o. To minimize the number of animals being used and to allow pairing of the data base when possible, animals were studied multiple times. Experiments in animals being restudied were carried out a minimum of one week apart. [0395]
  • The formulation of amorphous precipitate of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin, prepared as described above, provided effective control of blood glucose for almost 27 hours, compared with only about 21 hours for human insulin ultralente. The precipitate provided a significantly flatter and a more extended control of glucose levels than did human insulin ultralente. For example, the nadir of the blood glucose concentration was obtained after 1.5 hours for the precipitate, and then the glucose level rose to a fairly constant level. By comparison, the nadir for human insulin ultralente was reached after 9 hours, and after that, the blood glucose level rose relatively quickly. The glucose level at the nadir was 72 mg/dL for the derivatized insulin precipitate formulation, while it was 56 mg/dL for the. ultralente formulation. Finally, plasma insulin levels corroborate these observations, and correlate well with the greater flatness and extension of time action of the amorphous precipitate of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin compared with human insulin ultralente. [0396]
  • EXAMPLE 6 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human Insulin Tested in Dogs
  • The glucodynamics of two formulations containing crystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin, prepared as described in Preparation 19, or essentially as described in Preparation 19 was determined in in normal dogs, using essentially the protocol described in Example 5. One of two preparations of microcrystals was administered to each dog at a dose of 2 nmol/kg subcutaneously. The experiments were carried out one three different occasions. The data from these three experiments were combined. A total of ten dogs each received a 2 nmol/kg dose of one of two preparations. In a separate experiment, a dose of a formulation of microcrystals of B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin prepared essentially as described in Preparation 19 was administered subcutaneously to each of five dogs at a dose of 3 nmol/kg. Human insulin NPH (2 nmol/kg, n=5), and saline vehicle (n=5) served as controls. In each experiment, the dogs received a constant infusion of somatostatin to create a transient diabetic state. [0397]
  • The formulation of microcrystals comprising B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin, administered at 2 nmol/kg, had an effective time action of 27 hours, compared with 21 hours for human insulin NPH at the same dose. The glucodynamic profile showed less hypoglycemic tendency than human insulin NPH, which is an advantageous quality. At 3 nmol/kg, the microcrystals comprising B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin effectively controlled glucose levels for at least 30 hours. At the glucose nadir, about the same glucose level was obtained as that obtained after administration of human insulin NPH (namely, about 65 mg/dL). However, the duration of such depressed glucose levels was much shorter for the microcrystals comprising B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin (about 3 hours) compared with human insulin NPH (about 7.5 hours). After the nadir, blood glucose levels for the group receiving microcrystals comprising B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin varied only between 91 and 115 mg/dL up to 30 hours, after which no further data are available. In contrast, glucose levels in the group the received human insulin NPH at 2 nmol/kg varied from 89 to 145 after the nadir was reached. [0398]
  • EXAMPLE 7 Microcrystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human Insulin Tested in Dogs
  • The glucodynamics of formulations containing crystals of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin, prepared as described in Preparation 16, was determined in normal dogs, using essentially the protocol described in Example 5. The formulation of microcrystals comprising B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin, administered at 2 nmol/kg had an effective time action of 24 hours, compared with 24 hours for human insulin NPH at the same dose. The glucodynamic profile was flatter, showing less hypoglycemic tendency than human insulin NPH. At the glucose nadir, about the same glucose level was obtained as that obtained after administration of human insulin NPH (namely, about 67 mg/dL, versus 64 mg/dL for human insulin NPH). However, the duration of such depressed glucose levels was much shorter for the microcrystals comprising B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin (about 3 hours) compared with human insulin NPH (about 7.5 hours). [0399]
  • The principles, preferred embodiments and modes of operation of the present invention have been described in the foregoing specification. The invention which is intended to be protected herein, however, is not to be construed as limited to the particular forms disclosed, since they are to be regarded as illustrative rather than restrictive. Variations and changes may be made by those skilled in the art without departing from the spirit of the invention. [0400]

Claims (84)

I claim:
1. A microcrystal comprising:
a) a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of derivatized insulin, derivatized insulin analogs, and derivatized proinsulins;
b) a complexing compound;
c) a hexamer-stabilizing compound; and
d) a divalent metal cation.
2. The microcrystal of claim 1, wherein the completing compound is protamine which is present at about 0.15 mg to about 0.5 mg per 3.5 mg of derivatized protein.
3. The microcrystal of claim 2, wherein the divalent metal cation is zinc, which is present at about 0.3 mole to about 0.7 mole per mole of derivatized protein.
4. The microcrystal of claim 3, wherein the hexamer-stabilizing compound is a phenolic preservative selected from the group consisting of phenol, m-cresol, o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, methylparaben, and mixtures thereof and is present in sufficient proportions with respect to the derivatized protein to facilitate formation of the R6 hexamer conformation.
5. The microcrystal of claim 4, wherein the derivatized protein is an acylated protein selected from the group consisting of acylated insulin and acylated insulin analogs.
6. The microcrystal of claim 5, wherein the derivatized protein is a fatty acid-acylated insulin.
7. The microcrystal of claim 6, wherein the derivatized protein is insulin that is acylated with a straight-chain, saturated fatty acid.
8. The microcrystal of claim 7, wherein the derivatized protein is insulin that is mono-acylated at the LysB29-Nε amino group of insulin.
9. The microcrystal of claim 8, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-hexanoic acid, n-heptanoic acid, n-octanoic acid, n-nonanoic acid, and n-decanoic acid.
10. The microcrystal of claim 9, wherein the derivatized protein is selected from the group consisting of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin, B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin, and B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin.
11. The microcrystal of claim 8, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-dodecanoic acid, n-tetradecanoic acid, and n-hexadecanoic acid.
12. The microcrystal of claim 7, wherein the Am fatty acid-acylated insulin is a di-acylated insulin that is acylated at the LysB29-Nε-amino group and is also acylated at one N-terminal Nα-amino group, and wherein the fatty acid is selected from the group consisting of n-hexanoic acid, n-heptanoic acid, n-octanoic acid, n-nonanoic acid, and n-decanoic acid.
13. The microcrystal of claim 6, wherein the derivatized protein is insulin that is acylated with a branched-chain, saturated fatty acid.
14. The microcrystal of claim 13, wherein the branched, saturated fatty acid has from three to ten carbon atoms in its longest branch.
15. The microcrystal of claim 5, wherein the derivatized protein is a fatty acid-acylated insulin analog.
16. The microcrystal of claim 15, wherein the derivatized protein is an insulin analog that is acylated with a straight-chain, saturated fatty acid.
17. The microcrystal of claim 16, wherein the derivatized protein is mono-acylated at the Nε-amino group.
18. The microcrystal of claim 17, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-hexanoic acid, n-heptanoic acid, n-octanoic acid, n-nonanoic acid, and n-decanoic acid.
19. The microcrystal of claim 18, wherein the derivatized protein is selected from the group consisting of fatty acid-acylated animal insulins, fatty acid-acylated monomeric insulin analogs, fatty acid-acylated deletion analogs, and fatty acid-acylated pI-shifted insulin analogs.
20. The microcrystal of claim 19, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog, fatty acid-acylated LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog, or fatty acid-acylated AspB28-human insulin analog.
21. The microcrystal of claim 20, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog.
22. The microcrystal of claim 17, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-dodecanoic acid, n-tetradecanoic acid, and n-hexadecanoic acid.
23. The microcrystal of claim 22, wherein the derivatized protein is selected from the group consisting of fatty acid-acylated animal insulins, fatty acid-acylated monomeric insulin analogs, fatty acid-acylated deletion analogs, and fatty acid-acylated pI-shifted insulin analogs.
24. The microcrystal of claim 23, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog, fatty acid-acylated LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog, or fatty acid-acylated AspB28-human insulin analog.
25. The microcrystal of claim 24, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog.
26. The microcrystal of claim 25, wherein the derivatized protein is B29-Nε-myristoyl-des(B30)-human insulin analog.
27. The microcrystal of claim 26, wherein the derivatized protein is B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog.
28. The microcrystal of claim 15, wherein the derivatized protein is an insulin analog that is acylated with a branched-chain, saturated fatty acid.
29. The microcrystal of claim 28, wherein the branched chain, saturated fatty acid has from three to ten carbon atoms in its longest branch.
30. The microcrystal of claim 1, wherein the microcrystal has rod-like morphology.
31. The microcrystal of claim 1, wherein the A microcrystal has irregular morphology.
32. A suspension formulation comprising an insoluble phase and a solution phase, wherein the insoluble phase is comprised of the microcrystal of claim 1, and the solution phase is comprised of water.
33. A suspension formulation comprising an insoluble phase and a solution phase, wherein the insoluble phase is comprised of the microcrystal of claim 2 and the solution phase is comprised of water.
34. The suspension formulation of claim 33, wherein the solution phase is further comprised of a phenolic preservative at a concentration of about 0.5 mg per mL to about 6 mg per mL of solution, a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer, and an isotonicity agent.
35. The suspension formulation of claim 34, wherein the solution phase is further comprised of insulin, an insulin analog, an acylated insulin, or an acylated insulin analog.
36. The suspension formulation of claim 35, wherein the solution phase is comprised of insulin.
37. The suspension formulation of claim 35, wherein the solution phase is comprised of an insulin analog.
38. The suspension formulation of claim 37, wherein the insulin analog is a monomeric insulin analog.
39. The suspension formulation of claim 38, wherein the insulin analog is LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog.
40. The suspension formulation of claim 32, wherein the solution phase is further comprised of zinc and protamine, wherein the ratio of zinc to derivatized protein in the suspension formulation is from about 5 to about 7 mole of zinc atoms per mole of derivatized protein, and the ratio of protamine to derivatized protein in the suspension formulation is from about 0.25 mg to about 0.5 mg per mg of derivatized protein.
41. A process for preparing the microcrystal of claim 1 comprising:
a) dissolving a derivatized protein, a hexamer-stabilizing compound, and a divalent metal cation in an aqueous solvent having a pH that will permit the formation of hexamers of the derivatized protein, and
b) adding a complexing compound.
42. A process for preparing the microcrystal of claim 1 comprising:
a) dissolving a derivatized protein, a hexamer-stabilizing compound, and a divalent metal cation in an aqueous solvent having a pH that will not permit the formation of hexamers of the derivatized protein, and
b) adjusting the pH to between about 6.8 and about 7.8; and
c) adding a completing compound.
43. A method of treating diabetes comprising administering the formulation of claim 32 to a patient in need thereof in a quantity sufficient to regulate blood glucose levels in the patient.
44. An amorphous precipitate comprising:
a) a derivatized protein selected from the group consisting of derivatized insulin, derivatized insulin analogs, and derivatized proinsulins;
b) a completing compound;
c) a hexamer-stabilizing compound; and
d) a divalent metal cation.
45. The amorphous precipitate of claim 44, wherein the complexing compound is protamine which is present at about 0.15 mg to about 0.5 mg per 3.5 mg of derivatized protein.
46. The amorphous precipitate of claim 45, wherein the divalent metal cation is zinc, which is present at about a 0.3 mole to about 0.7 mole per mole of derivatized protein.
47. The amorphous precipitate of claim 46, wherein the hexamer-stabilizing compound is a phenolic preservative selected from the group consisting of phenol, m-cresol, o-cresol, p-cresol, chlorocresol, methylparaben, and mixtures thereof and is present in sufficient proportions with respect to the derivatized protein to facilitate formation of the R6 hexamer conformation.
48. The amorphous precipitate of claim 47, wherein the derivatized protein is an acylated protein selected from the group consisting of acylated insulin and acylated insulin analogs.
49. The amorphous precipitate of claim 48, wherein the derivatized protein is a fatty acid-acylated insulin.
50. The amorphous precipitate of claim 49, wherein the derivatized protein is insulin that is acylated with a straight-chain, saturated fatty acid.
51. The amorphous precipitate of claim 50, wherein the derivatized protein is insulin that is mono-acylated at the LysB29-Nε amino group of insulin.
52. The amorphous precipitate of claim 51, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-hexanoic acid, n-heptanoic acid, n-octanoic acid, n-nonanoic acid, and n-decanoic acid.
53. The amorphous precipitate of claim 52, wherein the derivatized protein is selected from the group consisting of B29-Nε-hexanoyl-human insulin, B29-Nε-octanoyl-human insulin, and B29-Nε-decanoyl-human insulin.
54. The amorphous precipitate of claim 51, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-dodecanoic acid, n-tetradecanoic acid, and n-hexadecanoic acid.
55. The amorphous precipitate of claim 50, wherein the fatty acid-acylated insulin is a di-acylated insulin that is acylated at the LysB29-Nε-amino group and is also acylated at one N-terminal Nα-amino group, and wherein the fatty acid is selected from the group consisting of n-hexanoic acid, n-heptanoic acid, n-octanoic acid, n-nonanoic acid, and n-decanoic acid.
56. The amorphous precipitate of claim 49, wherein the derivatized protein is insulin that is acylated with a branched-chain, saturated fatty acid.
57. The amorphous precipitate of claim 56, wherein the branched, saturated fatty acid has from three to ten carbon atoms in its longest branch.
58. The amorphous precipitate of claim 48, wherein the derivatized protein is a fatty acid-acylated insulin analog.
59. The amorphous precipitate of claim 58, wherein the derivatized protein is an insulin analog that is acylated with a straight-chain, saturated fatty acid.
60. The amorphous precipitate of claim 59, wherein the derivatized protein is mono-acylated at the Nε-amino group.
61. The amorphous precipitate of claim 60, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-hexanoic acid, an-heptanoic acid, n-octanoic acid, n-nonanoic acid, and n-decanoic acid.
62. The amorphous precipitate of claim 61, wherein the derivatized protein is selected from the group consisting of fatty acid-acylated animal insulins, fatty acid-acylated monomeric insulin analogs, fatty acid-acylated deletion analogs, and fatty acid-acylated pI-shifted insulin analogs.
63. The amorphous precipitate of claim 62, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog, fatty acid-acylated 30 LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog, or fatty acid-acylated AspB28-human insulin analog.
64. The amorphous precipitate of claim 63, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog.
65. The amorphous precipitate of claim 60, wherein the derivatized protein is acylated with a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of n-dodecanoic acid, n-tetradecanoic acid, and n-hexadecanoic acid.
66. The amorphous precipitate of claim 65, wherein the derivatized protein is selected from the group consisting of fatty acid-acylated animal insulins, fatty acid-acylated monomeric insulin analogs, fatty acid-acylated deletion analogs, and fatty acid-acylated pI-shifted insulin analogs.
67. The amorphous precipitate of claim 66, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog, fatty acid-acylated LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog, or fatty acid-acylated AspB28-human insulin analog.
68. The amorphous precipitate of claim 67, wherein the derivatized protein is fatty acid-acylated des(B30)-human insulin analog.
69. The amorphous precipitate of claim 68, wherein the derivatized protein is B29-Nε-myristoyl-des(B30)-human insulin analog.
70. The amorphous precipitate of claim 69, wherein the derivatized protein is B28-Nε-myristoyl-LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog.
71. The amorphous precipitate of claim 58, wherein the derivatized protein is an insulin analog that is acylated with a branched-chain, saturated fatty acid.
72. The amorphous precipitate of claim 71, wherein the branched chain, saturated fatty acid has from three to ten carbon atoms in its longest branch.
73. A suspension formulation comprising an insoluble phase and a solution phase, wherein the insoluble phase is comprised of the amorphous precipitate of claim 44, and the solution phase is comprised of water.
74. A suspension formulation comprising an insoluble phase and a solution phase, wherein the insoluble phase is comprised of the amorphous precipitate of claim 45 and the solution phase is comprised of water.
75. The suspension formulation of claim 41, wherein the solution phase is further comprised of a phenolic preservative at a concentration of about 0.5 mg per mL to about 6 mg per mL of solution, a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer, and an isotonicity agent.
76. The suspension formulation of claim 75, wherein the solution phase is further comprised of insulin, an insulin analog, an acylated insulin, or an acylated insulin analog.
77. The suspension formulation of claim 76, wherein the solution phase is comprised of insulin.
78. The suspension formulation of claim 76, wherein the solution phase is comprised of an insulin analog.
79. The suspension formulation of claim 78, wherein the insulin analog is a monomeric insulin analog.
80. The suspension formulation of claim 79, wherein the insulin analog is LysB28, ProB29-human insulin analog.
81. The suspension formulation of claim 73, wherein the solution phase is further comprised of zinc and protamine, wherein the ratio of zinc to derivatized protein in the suspension formulation is from about 5 to about 7 mole of zinc atoms per mole of derivatized protein, and the ratio of protamine to derivatized protein in the suspension formulation is from about 0.25 mg to about 0.5 mg per mg of derivatized protein.
82. A process for preparing the amorphous precipitate of claim 45 comprising:
a) dissolving a derivatized protein, a hexamer-stabilizing compound, and a divalent metal cation in an aqueous solvent having a pH that will permit the formation of hexamers of the derivatized protein, and
b) adding a completing compound.
83. A process for preparing the amorphous precipitate of claim 45 comprising:
a) dissolving a derivatized protein, a hexamer-stabilizing compound, and a divalent metal cation in an aqueous solvent having a pH that will not permit the formation of hexamers of the derivatized protein, and
b) adjusting the pH to between about 6.8 and about 7.8; and
c) adding a completing compound.
84. A method of treating diabetes comprising administering the formulation of claim 73 to a patient in need thereof in a quantity sufficient to regulate blood glucose levels in the patient.
US10/010,038 1997-10-24 2001-12-06 Insoluble insulin compositions Abandoned US20020082199A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US10/010,038 US20020082199A1 (en) 1997-10-24 2001-12-06 Insoluble insulin compositions

Applications Claiming Priority (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US6310497P 1997-10-24 1997-10-24
US8893098P 1998-06-11 1998-06-11
US09/177,685 US6268335B1 (en) 1997-10-24 1998-10-22 Insoluble insulin compositions
US09/761,903 US6465426B2 (en) 1997-10-24 2001-01-17 Insoluble insulin compositions
US10/010,038 US20020082199A1 (en) 1997-10-24 2001-12-06 Insoluble insulin compositions

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/761,903 Continuation US6465426B2 (en) 1997-10-24 2001-01-17 Insoluble insulin compositions

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20020082199A1 true US20020082199A1 (en) 2002-06-27

Family

ID=26743043

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/177,685 Expired - Lifetime US6268335B1 (en) 1997-10-24 1998-10-22 Insoluble insulin compositions
US09/761,903 Expired - Fee Related US6465426B2 (en) 1997-10-24 2001-01-17 Insoluble insulin compositions
US10/010,038 Abandoned US20020082199A1 (en) 1997-10-24 2001-12-06 Insoluble insulin compositions

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/177,685 Expired - Lifetime US6268335B1 (en) 1997-10-24 1998-10-22 Insoluble insulin compositions
US09/761,903 Expired - Fee Related US6465426B2 (en) 1997-10-24 2001-01-17 Insoluble insulin compositions

Country Status (21)

Country Link
US (3) US6268335B1 (en)
EP (1) EP1039920A4 (en)
JP (2) JP2001521004A (en)
KR (1) KR20010024556A (en)
CN (1) CN1276731A (en)
AR (1) AR020047A1 (en)
AU (2) AU747926B2 (en)
BR (1) BR9813111A (en)
CA (2) CA2306877A1 (en)
CO (1) CO4970769A1 (en)
EA (1) EA200000453A1 (en)
HR (1) HRP20000236A2 (en)
HU (1) HUP0004169A3 (en)
ID (1) ID24890A (en)
IL (1) IL134901A0 (en)
NO (1) NO20002038L (en)
PE (1) PE123799A1 (en)
PL (1) PL340255A1 (en)
SV (1) SV1998000125A (en)
TR (1) TR200001050T2 (en)
WO (2) WO1999021578A1 (en)

Cited By (16)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2004080481A1 (en) * 2003-03-13 2004-09-23 Novo Nordisk A/S Novel nph insulin preparations
US20050176621A1 (en) * 2001-12-19 2005-08-11 Brader Mark L. Crystalline compositions for controlling blood glucose
US20060241019A1 (en) * 2003-07-25 2006-10-26 Bridon Dominique P Long lasting insulin derivatives and methods thereof
US20060258561A1 (en) * 2003-03-13 2006-11-16 Novo Nordisk A/S Novel NPH insulin preparations
US20090304814A1 (en) * 2006-01-06 2009-12-10 Case Western Reserve University Fibrillation resistant proteins
US20100099601A1 (en) * 2006-10-04 2010-04-22 Case Western Reserve University Fibrillation-resistant insulin and insulin analogues
US7872095B2 (en) 2004-07-19 2011-01-18 Biocon Limited Insulin-oligomer conjugates, formulations and uses thereof
US20110059887A1 (en) * 2008-04-14 2011-03-10 Case Western Reserve University Meal-time insulin analogues of enhanced stability
US20110077196A1 (en) * 2009-09-17 2011-03-31 Case Western Reserve University Non-standard insulin analogues
US20110166064A1 (en) * 2008-07-31 2011-07-07 Case Western Reserve University Halogen-stabilized insulin
US20110195896A1 (en) * 2008-04-22 2011-08-11 Case Western Reserve University Isoform-specific insulin analogues
US9079975B2 (en) 2009-12-11 2015-07-14 Case Western Reserve University Insulin analogues with chlorinated amino acids
US9200053B2 (en) 2008-07-31 2015-12-01 Case Western Reserve University Insulin analogues containing penta-fluoro-Phenylalanine at position B24
US9241908B2 (en) 2007-10-16 2016-01-26 Biocon Limited Orally administrable solid pharmaceutical composition and a process thereof
US10392429B2 (en) 2014-10-06 2019-08-27 Case Western Reserve University Biphasic single-chain insulin analogues
US20190343768A1 (en) * 2018-05-14 2019-11-14 Dance Biopharm Inc. Insulin formulations for reconstitution into high concentration liquid solutions

Families Citing this family (93)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6444641B1 (en) 1997-10-24 2002-09-03 Eli Lilly Company Fatty acid-acylated insulin analogs
CO4970787A1 (en) * 1997-12-23 2000-11-07 Lilly Co Eli INSOLUBLE COMPOSITIONS OF INSULIN AND INSULIN DERIVATIVES THAT CONTROL BLOOD GLUCOSE
US7169889B1 (en) * 1999-06-19 2007-01-30 Biocon Limited Insulin prodrugs hydrolyzable in vivo to yield peglylated insulin
CN1406131A (en) * 2000-12-25 2003-03-26 株式会社资生堂 Sympathetic-activating perfume composition
US7060675B2 (en) * 2001-02-15 2006-06-13 Nobex Corporation Methods of treating diabetes mellitus
US20020155614A1 (en) * 2001-02-21 2002-10-24 Tomlinson Andrew J. Peptide esterification
US6828305B2 (en) * 2001-06-04 2004-12-07 Nobex Corporation Mixtures of growth hormone drug-oligomer conjugates comprising polyalkylene glycol, uses thereof, and methods of making same
US6835802B2 (en) 2001-06-04 2004-12-28 Nobex Corporation Methods of synthesizing substantially monodispersed mixtures of polymers having polyethylene glycol moieties
US6713452B2 (en) 2001-06-04 2004-03-30 Nobex Corporation Mixtures of calcitonin drug-oligomer conjugates comprising polyalkylene glycol, uses thereof, and methods of making same
US7713932B2 (en) 2001-06-04 2010-05-11 Biocon Limited Calcitonin drug-oligomer conjugates, and uses thereof
US6828297B2 (en) 2001-06-04 2004-12-07 Nobex Corporation Mixtures of insulin drug-oligomer conjugates comprising polyalkylene glycol, uses thereof, and methods of making same
JP2005508895A (en) * 2001-08-28 2005-04-07 イーライ・リリー・アンド・カンパニー Premix of GLP-1 and basal insulin
US7312192B2 (en) * 2001-09-07 2007-12-25 Biocon Limited Insulin polypeptide-oligomer conjugates, proinsulin polypeptide-oligomer conjugates and methods of synthesizing same
US7030082B2 (en) * 2001-09-07 2006-04-18 Nobex Corporation Pharmaceutical compositions of drug-oligomer conjugates and methods of treating disease therewith
US6770625B2 (en) 2001-09-07 2004-08-03 Nobex Corporation Pharmaceutical compositions of calcitonin drug-oligomer conjugates and methods of treating diseases therewith
US7166571B2 (en) * 2001-09-07 2007-01-23 Biocon Limited Insulin polypeptide-oligomer conjugates, proinsulin polypeptide-oligomer conjugates and methods of synthesizing same
US6913903B2 (en) * 2001-09-07 2005-07-05 Nobex Corporation Methods of synthesizing insulin polypeptide-oligomer conjugates, and proinsulin polypeptide-oligomer conjugates and methods of synthesizing same
DK1429731T3 (en) * 2001-09-19 2007-05-14 Elan Pharma Int Ltd Nanoparticle formulations containing insulin
IL161848A0 (en) * 2001-12-20 2005-11-20 Lilly Co Eli Insulin moldecule having protracted time action
US20040038864A1 (en) * 2002-06-27 2004-02-26 Per Balschmidt Use of dimethyl sulfone as isotonicity agent
US20050054818A1 (en) * 2003-07-02 2005-03-10 Brader Mark Laurence Crystalline compositions for controlling blood glucose
EP2107069B1 (en) 2003-08-05 2013-01-16 Novo Nordisk A/S Novel insulin derivatives
CN102816228A (en) * 2003-12-03 2012-12-12 诺和诺德公司 Single-chain insulin
US8263551B2 (en) 2004-11-22 2012-09-11 Novo Nordisk A/S Soluble, stable insulin-containing formulations with a protamine salt
EP1679065A1 (en) * 2005-01-07 2006-07-12 OctoPlus Sciences B.V. Controlled release compositions for interferon based on PEGT/PBT block copolymers
EP1863840A1 (en) * 2005-03-18 2007-12-12 Novo Nordisk A/S Pegylated single-chain insulin
EP1969004B1 (en) 2005-12-28 2011-08-10 Novo Nordisk A/S Compositions comprising an acylated insulin and zinc and method of making the said compositions
US8927015B2 (en) * 2006-04-12 2015-01-06 Emisphere Technologies, Inc. Formulations for delivering insulin
WO2007134151A2 (en) * 2006-05-10 2007-11-22 Smithkline Beecham Corporation Composition and method for increasing cell permeability of a compound
WO2007135118A1 (en) * 2006-05-24 2007-11-29 Novo Nordisk A/S Soluble, stable insulin-containing formulations
EP2049149B1 (en) 2006-07-31 2015-04-15 Novo Nordisk A/S Pegylated extended insulins
CA2663074A1 (en) 2006-09-22 2008-03-27 Novo Nordisk A/S Protease resistant insulin analogues
EP2152245B1 (en) 2007-04-30 2015-12-02 Novo Nordisk A/S Method for drying a protein composition, a dried protein composition and a pharmaceutical composition comprising the dried protein
EP2167032B1 (en) 2007-06-13 2019-08-07 Novo Nordisk A/S Pharmaceutical formulation comprising an insulin derivative
CA2695970A1 (en) * 2007-08-15 2009-02-19 Novo Nordisk A\S Insulin analogues with an acyl and aklylene glycol moiety
BRPI0907119A2 (en) 2008-01-09 2015-07-14 Sanofi Aventis Deutschland Insulin derivatives having an extremely delayed time action profile
DE102008003566A1 (en) * 2008-01-09 2009-07-16 Sanofi-Aventis Deutschland Gmbh New insulin analogs useful for treating diabetes
HUE030537T2 (en) * 2008-01-09 2017-05-29 Sanofi Aventis Deutschland Novel insulin derivatives having an extremely delayed time-action profile
US9260502B2 (en) 2008-03-14 2016-02-16 Novo Nordisk A/S Protease-stabilized insulin analogues
PL2910570T3 (en) 2008-03-18 2017-06-30 Novo Nordisk A/S Protease stabilized, acylated insulin analogues
NZ592283A (en) 2008-10-17 2012-09-28 Sanofi Aventis Deutschland Combination of an insulin and the GLP-1 agonist AVE0010
JP4959005B2 (en) 2008-10-30 2012-06-20 ノボ・ノルデイスク・エー/エス Treatment of diabetes mellitus with insulin injections less than daily injection frequency
AU2010208305A1 (en) 2009-01-28 2011-09-08 Smartcells, Inc. Synthetic conjugates and uses thereof
PE20120583A1 (en) 2009-01-28 2012-05-19 Smartcells Inc CONJUGATE-BASED SYSTEMS FOR CONTROLLED PHARMACOLOGICAL DELIVERY
US20100198188A1 (en) * 2009-02-05 2010-08-05 Abbott Diabetes Care Inc. Devices and Methods for Metering Insoluble Active Agent Particles
WO2010107519A1 (en) 2009-03-20 2010-09-23 Smartcells, Inc. Terminally-functionalized conjugates and uses thereof
TW201113032A (en) * 2009-07-06 2011-04-16 Sanofi Aventis Deutschland Slow-acting insulin preparations
EP2451472A1 (en) * 2009-07-06 2012-05-16 Sanofi-Aventis Deutschland GmbH Heat- and vibration-stable insulin preparations
MX2012005186A (en) 2009-11-13 2012-06-08 Sanofi Aventis Deutschland Pharmaceutical composition comprising a glp-1 agonist, an insulin, and methionine.
MX2012005184A (en) 2009-11-13 2012-06-08 Sanofi Aventis Deutschland Pharmaceutical composition comprising a glp-1 agonist and methionine.
EP2504019A2 (en) 2009-11-25 2012-10-03 ArisGen SA Mucosal delivery composition comprising a peptide complexed with a crown compound and/or a counter ion
AU2011202239C1 (en) 2010-05-19 2017-03-16 Sanofi Long-acting formulations of insulins
RU2598273C2 (en) * 2010-06-23 2016-09-20 Ново Нордиск А/С Insulin derivatives containing additional disulfide bonds
JP6199186B2 (en) 2010-08-30 2017-09-20 サノフィ−アベンティス・ドイチュラント・ゲゼルシャフト・ミット・ベシュレンクテル・ハフツング Use of AVE0010 for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of type 2 diabetes
DK2632478T3 (en) 2010-10-27 2019-10-07 Novo Nordisk As TREATMENT OF DIABETES MELITUS USING INSULIN INJECTIONS SUBMITTED AT VARIOUS INJECTION INTERVALS
US9821032B2 (en) 2011-05-13 2017-11-21 Sanofi-Aventis Deutschland Gmbh Pharmaceutical combination for improving glycemic control as add-on therapy to basal insulin
EP2720711A1 (en) 2011-06-15 2014-04-23 Novo Nordisk A/S Multi substituted insulins
SI2750699T1 (en) 2011-08-29 2015-11-30 Sanofi-Aventis Deutschland Gmbh Pharmaceutical combination for use in glycemic control in diabetes type 2 patients
TWI559929B (en) 2011-09-01 2016-12-01 Sanofi Aventis Deutschland Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment of a neurodegenerative disease
AU2013247047A1 (en) 2012-04-11 2014-10-23 Novo Nordisk A/S Insulin formulations
JP6735561B2 (en) 2012-12-03 2020-08-05 メルク・シャープ・アンド・ドーム・コーポレーションMerck Sharp & Dohme Corp. O-glycosylated carboxy-terminal portion (CTP) peptide-based insulin and insulin analogs
TWI780236B (en) 2013-02-04 2022-10-11 法商賽諾菲公司 Stabilized pharmaceutical formulations of insulin analogues and/or insulin derivatives
AU2014247167B2 (en) 2013-04-03 2018-11-22 Sanofi Treatment of diabetes mellitus by long–acting formulations of insulins
US10137172B2 (en) 2013-04-30 2018-11-27 Novo Nordisk A/S Administration regime
US9896496B2 (en) 2013-10-07 2018-02-20 Novo Nordisk A/S Derivative of an insulin analogue
CN114939156A (en) * 2014-01-09 2022-08-26 赛诺菲 Stabilized pharmaceutical formulations of insulin aspart
US9895424B2 (en) 2014-01-09 2018-02-20 Sanofi Stabilized pharmaceutical formulations of insulin analogues and/or insulin derivatives
EP3091995B1 (en) 2014-01-09 2024-03-20 Sanofi Stabilized pharmaceutical formulations of insulin aspart
AR099569A1 (en) 2014-02-28 2016-08-03 Novo Nordisk As INSULIN DERIVATIVES AND THE MEDICAL USES OF THESE
EP3180021A4 (en) * 2014-08-11 2018-04-18 Albany Medical College Myristoylated leptin-related peptides and uses thereof
JP6970615B2 (en) 2014-12-12 2021-11-24 サノフィ−アベンティス・ドイチュラント・ゲゼルシャフト・ミット・ベシュレンクテル・ハフツング Insulin glargine / lixisenatide fixed ratio prescription
CN105884879A (en) * 2015-01-26 2016-08-24 漳州博欣生物技术有限公司 Chemical synthesis method of insulin analogue
TWI748945B (en) 2015-03-13 2021-12-11 德商賽諾菲阿凡提斯德意志有限公司 Treatment type 2 diabetes mellitus patients
TW201705975A (en) 2015-03-18 2017-02-16 賽諾菲阿凡提斯德意志有限公司 Treatment of type 2 diabetes mellitus patients
CN108026157B (en) * 2015-08-25 2022-11-25 诺和诺德股份有限公司 Novel insulin derivative and medical use thereof
CN105597087B (en) * 2016-01-06 2019-04-26 山东新时代药业有限公司 A kind of insulin glargine injecta and preparation method thereof
CA3035850A1 (en) 2016-09-06 2018-03-15 Chemical & Biopharmaceutical Laboratories Of Patras S.A. Proinsulin derivatives
EP3329930A1 (en) 2016-12-05 2018-06-06 Nuritas Limited Pharmaceuctical compositions
ES2932498T3 (en) 2016-12-05 2023-01-20 Nuritas Ltd Compositions comprising the peptide WKDEAGKPLVK
CN110087674B (en) 2016-12-16 2023-01-03 诺和诺德股份有限公司 Pharmaceutical composition containing insulin
WO2018200462A1 (en) * 2017-04-24 2018-11-01 Friedman Simon H Drug conjugates with photocleavable solubility modulators
JOP20190273A1 (en) * 2017-05-26 2019-11-24 Lilly Co Eli Acylated insulin compound
EP3727424A4 (en) 2017-12-18 2021-10-27 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Conjugate based systems for controlled insulin delivery
US11413352B2 (en) 2017-12-18 2022-08-16 Merck, Sharp & Dohme LLC Conjugate based systems for controlled insulin delivery
US10335464B1 (en) 2018-06-26 2019-07-02 Novo Nordisk A/S Device for titrating basal insulin
KR20210102346A (en) 2018-12-11 2021-08-19 사노피 insulin conjugate
CN110063932A (en) * 2019-04-12 2019-07-30 浙江大学 A kind of slow releasing composition preparation of polypeptide protein class drug and preparation method thereof
IL292762A (en) 2019-12-11 2022-07-01 Novo Nordisk As Novel insulin analogues and uses thereof
CR20220555A (en) 2020-03-31 2023-01-23 Protomer Tech Inc Conjugates for selective responsiveness to vicinal diols
MX2022014309A (en) 2020-05-15 2022-12-07 Lilly Co Eli Extended time action acylated insulin compounds.
AU2021382599A1 (en) 2020-11-19 2023-06-22 Protomer Technologies Inc. Aromatic boron-containing compounds and insulin analogs
US20240043493A1 (en) * 2020-12-07 2024-02-08 Case Western Reserve University Acylated single-chain insulin analogues
US20230374045A1 (en) 2022-05-18 2023-11-23 Protomer Technologies Inc. Aromatic boron-containing compounds and related insulin analogs

Family Cites Families (45)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US2538018A (en) 1944-04-04 1951-01-16 Nordisk Insulinlab Crystalline product of insulin and alkaline protein and process of making it
US2801953A (en) 1952-02-28 1957-08-06 Hoechst Ag Process of preparing crystallized insulin preparations
US2849370A (en) 1953-06-04 1958-08-26 Novo Terapeutisk Labortorium A Injectable insulin preparations with protracted effect and process of producing same
US3102077A (en) 1953-08-19 1963-08-27 Christensen Henry Marinus Preparation of insulin containing 2.75 to 8 percent zinc content
US3060093A (en) 1957-07-18 1962-10-23 Nordisk Insulinlab Slowly acting insulin preparation in crystalline form and method of preparation
DE1793517C3 (en) 1968-09-28 1974-12-05 Farbwerke Hoechst Ag, Vormals Meister Lucius & Bruening, 6000 Frankfurt N (Al), N (B29> bis (tert-butyloxycarbonyl) insulin and process for its preparation
US3869437A (en) 1970-05-08 1975-03-04 Nat Res Dev Mono-, di, and N{HD A1{B , N{HU B1{B , N{HU B29{B -tri-acylated insulin
US3950517A (en) 1970-05-08 1976-04-13 National Research Development Corporation Insulin derivatives
GB1381274A (en) 1971-01-28 1975-01-22 Nat Res Dev Insulin derivatives
US3868358A (en) 1971-04-30 1975-02-25 Lilly Co Eli Protamine-insulin product
US3865325A (en) 1971-07-02 1975-02-11 Dylaker Computer Systems Inc Flexible tape reel
US3907763A (en) 1972-03-01 1975-09-23 Bayer Ag Insulin derivatives crosslinked by a dicarboxylic acid moiety
US4183849A (en) 1975-01-15 1980-01-15 Nordisk Insulinlaboratorium Therapeutic insulin preparation and a process for the production of a stable insulin preparation with protracted effect
JPS55138393A (en) 1979-04-13 1980-10-29 Shionogi & Co Ltd Semisynthesis of insulin
JPS55138391A (en) 1979-04-13 1980-10-29 Shionogi & Co Ltd New synthetic method of peptide derivative
IE50892B1 (en) 1980-02-11 1986-08-06 Novo Industri As Process for preparing insulin esters
DE3101382A1 (en) 1981-01-17 1982-09-02 Hoechst Ag, 6000 Frankfurt "METHOD FOR PRODUCING HUMANISULIN OR ITS DERIVATIVES FROM PIG INSULIN OR ITS DERIVATIVES"
DK353781A (en) 1981-08-10 1983-02-11 Novo Industri As PROCEDURE FOR THE PREPARATION OF INSULIN DERIVATIVES
IT1189353B (en) 1982-06-07 1988-02-04 Nordisk Insulinlab PROCEDURE FOR THE PREPARATION OF HUMAN INSULIN AND ITS ESTERS
DE3326473A1 (en) 1983-07-22 1985-01-31 Hoechst Ag, 6230 Frankfurt PHARMACEUTICAL AGENT FOR TREATING THE DIABETES MELLITUS
DE3327709A1 (en) 1983-07-29 1985-02-07 Hoechst Ag, 6230 Frankfurt INSULIN DERIVATIVE CRYSTAL SUSPENSIONS, METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION AND USE THEREOF
US4946828A (en) * 1985-03-12 1990-08-07 Novo Nordisk A/S Novel insulin peptides
PH25772A (en) 1985-08-30 1991-10-18 Novo Industri As Insulin analogues, process for their preparation
JPH01254699A (en) 1988-04-05 1989-10-11 Kodama Kk Insulin derivative and use thereof
ATE93238T1 (en) 1988-07-20 1993-09-15 Novo Nordisk As HUMAN INSULIN PLANTS AND PREPARATIONS THEREOF.
DE3837825A1 (en) * 1988-11-08 1990-05-10 Hoechst Ag NEW INSULIN DERIVATIVES, THEIR USE AND A PHARMACEUTICAL PREPARATION CONTAINING THEM
HUT56857A (en) 1988-12-23 1991-10-28 Novo Nordisk As Human insulin analogues
NZ232375A (en) 1989-02-09 1992-04-28 Lilly Co Eli Insulin analogues modified at b29
US5514646A (en) 1989-02-09 1996-05-07 Chance; Ronald E. Insulin analogs modified at position 29 of the B chain
DK134189D0 (en) 1989-03-20 1989-03-20 Nordisk Gentofte INSULIN COMPOUNDS
DK72793D0 (en) * 1993-06-21 1993-06-21 Novo Nordisk As NEW PRODUCT
WO1995000550A1 (en) 1993-06-21 1995-01-05 Novo Nordisk A/S Aspb28 insulin crystals
PT792290E (en) * 1993-09-17 2002-01-30 Novo Nordisk As INSULINA ACILADA
US5461031A (en) * 1994-06-16 1995-10-24 Eli Lilly And Company Monomeric insulin analog formulations
US5474978A (en) 1994-06-16 1995-12-12 Eli Lilly And Company Insulin analog formulations
US5597893A (en) 1994-10-31 1997-01-28 Eli Lilly And Company Preparation of stable insulin analog crystals
US5693609A (en) * 1994-11-17 1997-12-02 Eli Lilly And Company Acylated insulin analogs
US5646242A (en) * 1994-11-17 1997-07-08 Eli Lilly And Company Selective acylation of epsilon-amino groups
EP0871665B1 (en) * 1995-03-17 2003-07-23 Novo Nordisk A/S Insulin derivatives
US5700904A (en) * 1995-06-07 1997-12-23 Eli Lilly And Company Preparation of an acylated protein powder
US5877153A (en) 1996-06-11 1999-03-02 Commonwealth Biotechnologies Inc. Heparin-binding peptides
US5948751A (en) 1996-06-20 1999-09-07 Novo Nordisk A/S X14-mannitol
JP4472027B2 (en) 1996-06-20 2010-06-02 ノボ ノルディスク アクティーゼルスカブ Carbohydrate-containing insulin preparation
AU5749198A (en) 1997-02-07 1998-08-26 Novo Nordisk A/S Crystallisation of proteins
ZA989744B (en) 1997-10-31 2000-04-26 Lilly Co Eli Method for administering acylated insulin.

Cited By (28)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20050176621A1 (en) * 2001-12-19 2005-08-11 Brader Mark L. Crystalline compositions for controlling blood glucose
WO2004080481A1 (en) * 2003-03-13 2004-09-23 Novo Nordisk A/S Novel nph insulin preparations
US20060258561A1 (en) * 2003-03-13 2006-11-16 Novo Nordisk A/S Novel NPH insulin preparations
US20060241019A1 (en) * 2003-07-25 2006-10-26 Bridon Dominique P Long lasting insulin derivatives and methods thereof
US9102758B2 (en) 2004-07-19 2015-08-11 Biocon Limited Insulin-oligomer conjugates, formulations and uses thereof
US7872095B2 (en) 2004-07-19 2011-01-18 Biocon Limited Insulin-oligomer conjugates, formulations and uses thereof
US7875700B2 (en) 2004-07-19 2011-01-25 Biocon Limited Cation complexes of insulin compound conjugates, formulation and uses thereof
US9101596B2 (en) 2004-07-19 2015-08-11 Biocon Limited Cation complexes of insulin compound conjugates, formulations and uses thereof
US8563685B2 (en) 2004-07-19 2013-10-22 Biocon Limited Fatty acid formulations and oral delivery of proteins and peptides, and uses thereof
US8343914B2 (en) 2006-01-06 2013-01-01 Case Western Reserve University Fibrillation resistant proteins
US20090304814A1 (en) * 2006-01-06 2009-12-10 Case Western Reserve University Fibrillation resistant proteins
US8501440B2 (en) 2006-10-04 2013-08-06 Case Western Reserve University Fibrillation-resistant insulin and insulin analogues
US8192957B2 (en) 2006-10-04 2012-06-05 Case Western Reserve University Fibrillation-resistant insulin and insulin analogues
US20100099601A1 (en) * 2006-10-04 2010-04-22 Case Western Reserve University Fibrillation-resistant insulin and insulin analogues
US9241908B2 (en) 2007-10-16 2016-01-26 Biocon Limited Orally administrable solid pharmaceutical composition and a process thereof
US8993516B2 (en) 2008-04-14 2015-03-31 Case Western Reserve University Meal-time insulin analogues of enhanced stability
US20110059887A1 (en) * 2008-04-14 2011-03-10 Case Western Reserve University Meal-time insulin analogues of enhanced stability
US20110195896A1 (en) * 2008-04-22 2011-08-11 Case Western Reserve University Isoform-specific insulin analogues
US9388228B2 (en) 2008-07-31 2016-07-12 Case Western Reserve University Halogen-stabilized insulin
US8921313B2 (en) 2008-07-31 2014-12-30 Case Western Reserve University Halogen-stabilized insulin
US9200053B2 (en) 2008-07-31 2015-12-01 Case Western Reserve University Insulin analogues containing penta-fluoro-Phenylalanine at position B24
US20110166064A1 (en) * 2008-07-31 2011-07-07 Case Western Reserve University Halogen-stabilized insulin
US20110077196A1 (en) * 2009-09-17 2011-03-31 Case Western Reserve University Non-standard insulin analogues
US8399407B2 (en) 2009-09-17 2013-03-19 Case Western Reserve University Non-standard insulin analogues
US9079975B2 (en) 2009-12-11 2015-07-14 Case Western Reserve University Insulin analogues with chlorinated amino acids
US10392429B2 (en) 2014-10-06 2019-08-27 Case Western Reserve University Biphasic single-chain insulin analogues
US11142560B2 (en) 2014-10-06 2021-10-12 Case Western Reserve University Biphasic single-chain insulin analogues
US20190343768A1 (en) * 2018-05-14 2019-11-14 Dance Biopharm Inc. Insulin formulations for reconstitution into high concentration liquid solutions

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
CA2306905A1 (en) 1999-05-06
US6465426B2 (en) 2002-10-15
NO20002038L (en) 2000-06-26
WO1999021573A1 (en) 1999-05-06
NO20002038D0 (en) 2000-04-18
WO1999021578A1 (en) 1999-05-06
CN1276731A (en) 2000-12-13
AU1111799A (en) 1999-05-17
HUP0004169A3 (en) 2001-06-28
SV1998000125A (en) 1999-05-24
AU747926B2 (en) 2002-05-30
HRP20000236A2 (en) 2001-02-28
CO4970769A1 (en) 2000-11-07
TR200001050T2 (en) 2000-08-21
HUP0004169A2 (en) 2001-05-28
PE123799A1 (en) 1999-12-13
AU1116699A (en) 1999-05-17
EA200000453A1 (en) 2000-10-30
EP1039920A4 (en) 2003-05-28
KR20010024556A (en) 2001-03-26
PL340255A1 (en) 2001-01-29
IL134901A0 (en) 2001-05-20
US6268335B1 (en) 2001-07-31
JP2001521006A (en) 2001-11-06
EP1039920A1 (en) 2000-10-04
CA2306877A1 (en) 1999-05-06
US20010036916A1 (en) 2001-11-01
BR9813111A (en) 2000-08-15
ID24890A (en) 2000-08-31
JP2001521004A (en) 2001-11-06
AR020047A1 (en) 2002-04-10

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US6465426B2 (en) Insoluble insulin compositions
US6531448B1 (en) Insoluble compositions for controlling blood glucose
US20050176621A1 (en) Crystalline compositions for controlling blood glucose
EP0712861B1 (en) Acylated insulin analogs
US5547929A (en) Insulin analog formulations
JP2002543092A (en) Insulin crystals for pulmonary administration
WO2001087322A2 (en) Peptide pharmaceutical formulations
CZ154395A3 (en) Insulin analogous protamine complex, process of its preparation and parenteral pharmaceutical composition containing thereof
US20050054818A1 (en) Crystalline compositions for controlling blood glucose
EP0911035A2 (en) Insoluble insulin compositions
EP1396272A1 (en) Insoluble Insulin Compositions for Controlling Blood Glucose
EP1301200A2 (en) Peptide pharmaceutical formulations
MXPA00003955A (en) Insoluble insulin compositions
WO2001000675A1 (en) Protamine-free insoluble acylated insulin compositions
CZ20002339A3 (en) Insoluble compositions for influencing glucose in blood
CZ20001492A3 (en) Preparation of insoluble insulin
MXPA00006209A (en) Insoluble compositions for controlling blood glucose
AU734304B2 (en) Acylated insulin analogs

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION